blob: 3473ef00902a62b209e41a0a5b9d7729ff42fe98 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +000015#include "SemaInit.h"
John McCall7d384dd2009-11-18 07:57:50 +000016#include "Lookup.h"
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +000017#include "AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000022#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000023#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000025#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000026#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000027#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000028#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000030#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
31#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000032#include "clang/Parse/DeclSpec.h"
Chris Lattner418f6c72008-10-26 23:43:26 +000033#include "clang/Parse/Designator.h"
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +000034#include "clang/Parse/Scope.h"
Douglas Gregor314b97f2009-11-10 19:49:08 +000035#include "clang/Parse/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000036using namespace clang;
37
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000038
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000039/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
40/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
41///
42/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
43/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
44/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
45/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
46/// function is being used.
47///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000048/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
49/// decls.
50///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000051/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
52/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000053///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000054bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000055 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000056 if (D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000057 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000058 }
59
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000060 // See if the decl is unavailable
61 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
62 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
63 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
64 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000065
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000066 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000067 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000068 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
69 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
70 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
71 return true;
72 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000076}
77
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000078/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000079/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000080/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
81///
82void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000083 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000084 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000086 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000087
88 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
89 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000090 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
91 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000093 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
94 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000095 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +000096 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
97 int isMethod = 0;
98 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
99 // skip over named parameters.
100 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
101 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
102 if (nullPos)
103 --nullPos;
104 else
105 ++i;
106 }
107 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
108 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000109 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000110 // skip over named parameters.
111 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
112 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
113 if (nullPos)
114 --nullPos;
115 else
116 ++i;
117 }
118 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000119 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000120 // block or function pointer call.
121 QualType Ty = V->getType();
122 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000123 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000124 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
125 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
127 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
128 unsigned k;
129 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
130 if (nullPos)
131 --nullPos;
132 else
133 ++i;
134 }
135 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
136 }
137 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
138 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000139 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000140 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000141 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000142 return;
143
144 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000145 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000146 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000147 return;
148 }
149 int sentinel = i;
150 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
151 --sentinelPos;
152 ++i;
153 }
154 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
155 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000156 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000157 return;
158 }
159 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
160 ++i;
161 ++sentinel;
162 }
163 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000164 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
165 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
166 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
167 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isPointerType() &&
168 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
169 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
170 return;
171
172 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
173 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
174
175 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
176 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000177}
178
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000179SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
180 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
181 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
182}
183
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000184//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
185// Standard Promotions and Conversions
186//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
187
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000188/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
189void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
190 QualType Ty = E->getType();
191 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
192
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000193 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000194 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
Anders Carlssonb633c4e2009-09-01 20:37:18 +0000195 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000196 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
197 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
198 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
199 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
200 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
201 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
202 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000203 //
204 // C++ 4.2p1:
205 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
206 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
207 //
208 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
209 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000210 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
211 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000212 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000213}
214
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000215void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
216 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000217
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000218 QualType Ty = E->getType();
219 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
220 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
221 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
222 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
223 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
224 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
225 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
226 // rvalue is T
227 //
228 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000229 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
230 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000231 // type of the lvalue.
232 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
233 }
234}
235
236
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000237/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000238/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000239/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
240/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
241/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
242Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
243 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
244 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000246 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
247 //
248 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
249 // unsigned int may be used:
250 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
251 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
252 // and unsigned int.
253 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
254 //
255 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
256 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
257 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
258 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000259 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
260 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000261 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000262 return Expr;
263 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000264 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000265 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000266 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000267 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 }
269
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000270 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000271 return Expr;
272}
273
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000274/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000275/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000276/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
277void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
278 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
279 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000280
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000282 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
283 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
284 CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000285
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000286 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
287}
288
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000289/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
290/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
291/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
292/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000293bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
294 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000295 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000296
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000297 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
298 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
299 // etc.
300 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
301 return false;
302
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000303 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000304 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
305 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
306 << Expr->getType() << CT))
307 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000308
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000309 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000314
315 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000316}
317
318
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000319/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
320/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000321/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000322/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
323/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
324/// GCC.
325QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
326 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000327 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000329
330 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000331
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000332 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000333 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000334 QualType lhs =
335 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000336 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000337 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
339 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
340 if (lhs == rhs)
341 return lhs;
342
343 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
344 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
345 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
346 return lhs;
347
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000348 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000349 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000350 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
351 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000352 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000353 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
354 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
355
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000356 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000357 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +0000358 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
359 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000360 return destType;
361}
362
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000363//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
364// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
365//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
366
367
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000368/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000369/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
370/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
371/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
372/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000373///
374Action::OwningExprResult
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000376 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
377
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000378 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000379 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000381
382 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
383 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
384 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000385
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000386 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000387 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000388 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000389
390 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
John McCall4b7a8342010-03-15 10:54:44 +0000391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings )
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000392 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000393
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
395 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
396 // strings.
397 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000398 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000399 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000400
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000401 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000402 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
Chris Lattner2085fd62009-02-18 06:40:38 +0000403 Literal.GetStringLength(),
404 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
405 &StringTokLocs[0],
406 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000407}
408
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000409/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
410/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
411/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
412/// for values inside the block or for globals).
413///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000414/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000415/// up-to-date.
416///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000417static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000418 ValueDecl *VD) {
419 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
420 // we wanted to.
421 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
422 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000423
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
425 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
426 return false;
427
428 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
429 // snapshot it.
430 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
431 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000432 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
433 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000434
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000435 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
436 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
437
438 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
439 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
440 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
441 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000442 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
443 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000444
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000445 if (!NextBlock)
446 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000447
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000448 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
449 // having a reference outside it.
450 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
451 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000452
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000453 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
454 // a snapshot as well.
455 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
456 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000457
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000458 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459}
460
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000461
462
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +0000463/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000464Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000465Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000466 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000467 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
468 Diag(Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000469 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000470 << D->getDeclName();
471 return ExprError();
472 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000473
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000474 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000475 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
476 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
477 // visible.
478 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000479 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
480 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000481 Diag(Loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000482 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000484 << D->getIdentifier();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
487 }
488 }
489 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000491 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000492
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000493 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
494 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
495 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Douglas Gregor0da76df2009-11-23 11:41:28 +0000496 D, Loc, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000497}
498
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000499/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
500/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
501/// actual member.
502///
503/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
504/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
505/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
506/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
507/// we found.
508///
509/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
510/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
511/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
512VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
513 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000514 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
515 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
516 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
517
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000518 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000519 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
520 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
521 do {
522 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000523 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000524 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000525 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000526 else {
527 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
528 break;
529 }
530 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000531 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000532 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533
534 return BaseObject;
535}
536
537Sema::OwningExprResult
538Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
539 FieldDecl *Field,
540 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
541 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
542 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000543 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000544 AnonFields);
545
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000546 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
547 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
548 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
549 // found via name lookup.
550 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000551 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000552 if (BaseObject) {
553 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
554 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +0000555 if (BaseObjectExpr) BaseObjectExpr->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000556 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000557 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000558 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000559 BaseQuals
560 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
562 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
563 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
564 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
565 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000566 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
568 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
569 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000570 BaseQuals
571 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000572 } else {
573 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
574 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
575 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000576 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
577 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000578 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000579 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000580 = Context.getTagDeclType(
581 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
582 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000583 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000584 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
585 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
586 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000587 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000588 MD->getThisType(Context),
589 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000590 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
591 }
592 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000593 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
594 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000596 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000597 }
598
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000599 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000600 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
601 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000602 }
603
604 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
605 // anonymous struct/union.
606 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000607 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000608 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
609 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
610 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
611 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000612 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
613 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
614
615 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
616 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
617 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
618 ResultQuals.removeConst();
619
620 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
621 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
622
623 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
624 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
625
626 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
627 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
628 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
629
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000630 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000631 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000632 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000633 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
634 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000635 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000636 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000637 }
638
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000639 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000640}
641
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000642/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationName, its location, and
643/// possibly a list of template arguments.
644///
645/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
646/// DecomposeTemplateName.
647///
648/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
649/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
650/// some way.
651static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
652 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
653 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
654 DeclarationName &Name,
655 SourceLocation &NameLoc,
656 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
657 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
658 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
659 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
660
661 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
662 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
663 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
664 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
665 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
666
667 TemplateName TName =
668 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
669
670 Name = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName);
671 NameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
672 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
673 } else {
674 Name = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
675 NameLoc = Id.StartLocation;
676 TemplateArgs = 0;
677 }
678}
679
680/// Decompose the given template name into a list of lookup results.
681///
682/// The unqualified ID must name a non-dependent template, which can
683/// be more easily tested by checking whether DecomposeUnqualifiedId
684/// found template arguments.
685static void DecomposeTemplateName(LookupResult &R, const UnqualifiedId &Id) {
686 assert(Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId);
687 TemplateName TName =
688 Sema::TemplateTy::make(Id.TemplateId->Template).getAsVal<TemplateName>();
689
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000690 if (TemplateDecl *TD = TName.getAsTemplateDecl())
691 R.addDecl(TD);
John McCall0bd6feb2009-12-02 08:04:21 +0000692 else if (OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = TName.getAsOverloadedTemplate())
693 for (OverloadedTemplateStorage::iterator I = OT->begin(), E = OT->end();
694 I != E; ++I)
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000695 R.addDecl(*I);
John McCallb681b612009-11-22 02:49:43 +0000696
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +0000697 R.resolveKind();
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +0000698}
699
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000700/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
701/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
702/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000703static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000704 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
705 return false;
706
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000707 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
708 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
709 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
710 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
711 if (!BaseRT) return false;
712
713 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000714 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000715 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
716 return false;
717 }
718
719 return true;
720}
721
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000722/// Determines whether we can lookup this id-expression now or whether
723/// we have to wait until template instantiation is complete.
724static bool IsDependentIdExpression(Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000725 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000726
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000727 // If the qualifier scope isn't computable, it's definitely dependent.
728 if (!DC) return true;
729
730 // If the qualifier scope doesn't name a record, we can always look into it.
731 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) return false;
732
733 // We can't look into record types unless they're fully-formed.
734 if (!IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))) return true;
735
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000736 return false;
737}
John McCalle1599ce2009-11-30 23:50:49 +0000738
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
740/// the prospective base classes.
741static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
742 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
743 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000744 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000745 return false;
746
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000747 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000748 if (!RD) return false;
749 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
750
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000751 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
752 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
753 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
754 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
755 if (!BaseRT) return false;
756
757 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000758 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
759 return false;
760 }
761
762 return true;
763}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000764
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000765enum IMAKind {
766 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
767 IMA_Static,
768
769 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
770 IMA_Mixed,
771
772 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
773 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
774 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
775
776 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
777 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
778 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
779
780 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
781 IMA_Instance,
782
783 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
784 IMA_Unresolved,
785
786 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
787 /// context is not an instance method.
788 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
789
790 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
791 /// non-class context.
792 IMA_AnonymousMember,
793
794 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
795 /// context is not an instance method.
796 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
797
798 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
799 /// class.
800 IMA_Error_Unrelated
801};
802
803/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
804/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
805/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
806/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
807/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
808/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
809static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
810 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000811 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000812
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000813 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000814 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000815 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
816 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000817
818 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
819 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
820
821 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
822 bool hasNonInstance = false;
823 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
824 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000825 NamedDecl *D = *I;
826 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000827 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
828
829 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
830 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
831 // that's a special case.
832 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
833 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
834 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
835 }
836 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
837 }
838 else
839 hasNonInstance = true;
840 }
841
842 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
843 // member reference.
844 if (Classes.empty())
845 return IMA_Static;
846
847 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
848 // an implicit member reference.
849 if (isStaticContext)
850 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
851
852 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
853 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
854 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
855 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000856 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000857 Classes))
858 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
859
860 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
861}
862
863/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
864static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
865 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
866 const LookupResult &R) {
867 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
868 SourceRange Range(Loc);
869 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
870
871 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
872 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
873 if (MD->isStatic()) {
874 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
875 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
876 << Range << R.getLookupName();
877 return;
878 }
879 }
880
881 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
882 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
883 return;
884 }
885
886 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000887}
888
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000889/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
890///
891/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +0000892bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +0000893 LookupResult &R, CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000894 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
895
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000896 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000897 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000898 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
899 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000900 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000901 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000902 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
903 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000904
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000905 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
906 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
907 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
908 // dependent name.
909 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty()? CurContext : 0;
910 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000911 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
912 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
913
914 if (!R.empty()) {
915 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
916 R.suppressDiagnostics();
917
918 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
919 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
920 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
921 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
922
923 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
924 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
925 // Actually quite difficult!
926 if (isInstance)
927 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +0000928 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000929 else
930 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
931
932 // Do we really want to note all of these?
933 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
934 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
935
936 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
937 return false;
938 }
939 }
940 }
941
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000942 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000943 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000944 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000945 if (!R.empty()) {
946 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
947 if (SS.isEmpty())
948 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
949 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
950 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
951 else
952 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
953 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
954 << SS.getRange()
955 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
956 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
957 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
958 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
959 << ND->getDeclName();
960
961 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
962 return false;
963 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000964
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000965 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
966 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
967 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
968 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
969 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
970 // to recover well anyway.
971 if (SS.isEmpty())
972 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
973 else
974 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
975 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
976 << SS.getRange();
977
978 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
979 return true;
980 }
981 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000982 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000984 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000986 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000987 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000988 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
989 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000990 return true;
991 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000992 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000993 }
994
995 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
996 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
997 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
998 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
999 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1000 << SS.getRange();
1001 return true;
1002 }
1003
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001004 // Give up, we can't recover.
1005 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1006 return true;
1007}
1008
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001009Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001010 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001011 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1012 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1013 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
1014 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1015 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1016
1017 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001018 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001019
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001020 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001021
1022 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
1023 DeclarationName Name;
1024 SourceLocation NameLoc;
1025 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001026 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
1027 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001028
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001029 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001030
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001031 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1032 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001033 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1034 // (note: handled after lookup)
1035 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1036 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1037 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001038 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1039 // names a dependent type.
1040 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1041 // we need to handle these differently.
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001042 if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1043 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) ||
1044 (SS.isSet() && IsDependentIdExpression(*this, SS))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001045 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, Name, NameLoc,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00001046 isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001047 TemplateArgs);
1048 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001049
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001050 // Perform the required lookup.
1051 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1052 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001053 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1054 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1055 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1056 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1057 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001058 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1059 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1060 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001061 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001062 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
1063 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001064
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001065 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1066 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001067 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
1068 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001069 if (E.isInvalid())
1070 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001071
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001072 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1073 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001074 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001075 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001076
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001077 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1078 return ExprError();
1079
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001080 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1081 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001083
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001084 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001085 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1087 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1088 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1089 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1090 }
1091
1092 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1093 // call, diagnose the problem.
1094 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001095 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001096 return ExprError();
1097
1098 assert(!R.empty() &&
1099 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001100
1101 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1102 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001103 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001104 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1105 R.clear();
1106 OwningExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
1107 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1108 return move(E);
1109 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001110 }
1111 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001112
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001113 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1114 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1115
1116 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001117 // Warn about constructs like:
1118 // if (void *X = foo()) { ... } else { X }.
1119 // In the else block, the pointer is always false.
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001120 if (Var->isDeclaredInCondition() && Var->getType()->isScalarType()) {
1121 Scope *CheckS = S;
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001122 while (CheckS && CheckS->getControlParent()) {
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001123 if ((CheckS->getFlags() & Scope::ElseScope) &&
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001124 CheckS->getControlParent()->isDeclScope(DeclPtrTy::make(Var))) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001125 ExprError(Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_value_always_zero)
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001126 << Var->getDeclName()
Chris Lattner966c78b2010-04-12 06:12:50 +00001127 << (Var->getType()->isPointerType() ? 2 :
1128 Var->getType()->isBooleanType() ? 1 : 0));
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001129 break;
1130 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001131
Douglas Gregor9c4b8382009-11-05 17:49:26 +00001132 // Move to the parent of this scope.
1133 CheckS = CheckS->getParent();
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001134 }
1135 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001136 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001137 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1138 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1139 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1140 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1141 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1142 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001143 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001144 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001145
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001146 QualType T = Func->getType();
1147 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001148 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001149 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1150 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001151 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001152 }
1153 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001154
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001155 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
1156 // C++ [expr.prim.general]p6:
1157 // Within the definition of a non-static member function, an
1158 // identifier that names a non-static member is transformed to a
1159 // class member access expression.
1160 // But note that &SomeClass::foo is grammatically distinct, even
1161 // though we don't parse it that way.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001162 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001163 bool isAbstractMemberPointer = (isAddressOfOperand && !SS.isEmpty());
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001164 if (!isAbstractMemberPointer)
1165 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001166 }
1167
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 if (TemplateArgs)
1169 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001170
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001171 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1172}
1173
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001174/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
1175Sema::OwningExprResult
1176Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1177 LookupResult &R,
1178 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1179 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1180 case IMA_Instance:
1181 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1182
1183 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1184 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1185 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1186 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1187
1188 case IMA_Mixed:
1189 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1190 case IMA_Unresolved:
1191 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1192
1193 case IMA_Static:
1194 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1195 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1196 if (TemplateArgs)
1197 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1198 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1199
1200 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1201 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1202 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1203 return ExprError();
1204 }
1205
1206 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1207 return ExprError();
1208}
1209
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001210/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1211/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1212/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1213/// this path.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001214Sema::OwningExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001215Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001216 DeclarationName Name,
1217 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1218 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001219 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001220 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, Name, NameLoc, 0);
1221
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001222 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001223 return ExprError();
1224
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001225 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1226 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1227
1228 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1229 return ExprError();
1230
1231 if (R.empty()) {
1232 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
1233 return ExprError();
1234 }
1235
1236 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1237}
1238
1239/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1240/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1241/// additional lookup.
1242///
1243/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1244/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1245///
1246/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
1247Sema::OwningExprResult
1248Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001249 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001250 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001251 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001252
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001253 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1254 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1255 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1256 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1257 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1258
1259 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1260 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1261 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001262 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001263
1264 bool LookForIvars;
1265 if (Lookup.empty())
1266 LookForIvars = true;
1267 else if (IsClassMethod)
1268 LookForIvars = false;
1269 else
1270 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1271 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001272 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001273 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001274 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1276 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1277 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1278 if (IsClassMethod)
1279 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1280 << IV->getDeclName());
1281
1282 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1283 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1284 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1285 return ExprError();
1286
1287 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1288 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1289 return ExprError();
1290
1291 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1292 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1293 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1294 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1295
1296 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1297 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1298 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1299 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001300 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001301 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
1302 OwningExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
1303 SelfName, false, false);
1304 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1305 return Owned(new (Context)
1306 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1307 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1308 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001309 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001310 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001311 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001312 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1313 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1314 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1315 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1316 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1317 }
1318 }
1319
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001320 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1321 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1322 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1323 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1324 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1325 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1326 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1327 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1328 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1329 }
1330 }
1331 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001332 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1333 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001334}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001335
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001336/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1337///
1338/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1339///
1340/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1341/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1342/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1343/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1344///
1345/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1346/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1347/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1348/// the class declaring the member.
1349///
1350/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1351/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1352/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001353bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001354Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1355 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001356 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001357 NamedDecl *Member) {
1358 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1359 if (!RD)
1360 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001361
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001362 QualType DestRecordType;
1363 QualType DestType;
1364 QualType FromRecordType;
1365 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1366 bool PointerConversions = false;
1367 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1368 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001369
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001370 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1371 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1372 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1373 PointerConversions = true;
1374 } else {
1375 DestType = DestRecordType;
1376 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001377 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001378 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1379 if (Method->isStatic())
1380 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001381
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001382 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1383 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001384
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001385 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1386 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1387 PointerConversions = true;
1388 } else {
1389 FromRecordType = FromType;
1390 DestType = DestRecordType;
1391 }
1392 } else {
1393 // No conversion necessary.
1394 return false;
1395 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001396
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001397 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1398 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001399
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001400 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1401 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1402 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001403
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001404 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1405 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1406
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001407 bool isLvalue
1408 = (From->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) && !PointerConversions;
1409
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001410 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001411 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001412 // class name.
1413 //
1414 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1415 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1416 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1417 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1418 //
1419 // class Base { public: int x; };
1420 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1421 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1422 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1423 //
1424 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1425 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1426 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1427 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001428 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001429 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1430 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1431 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1432
1433 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1434
1435 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1436 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1437 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1438 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001439 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001440 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001441 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001442 return true;
1443
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001444 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001445 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001446 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001447 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001448
1449 FromType = QType;
1450 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1451
1452 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1453 // we're done.
1454 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1455 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001456 }
1457 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001458
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001459 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001460
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001461 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1462 // down to the using declaration's type.
1463 //
1464 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1465 // class ever has member declarations.
1466 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1467 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1468 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1469 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1470
1471 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1472 // conversion is non-trivial.
1473 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1474 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001475 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001476 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001477 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001478 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001479
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001480 QualType UType = URecordType;
1481 if (PointerConversions)
1482 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001483 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001484 isLvalue, BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001485 FromType = UType;
1486 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1487 }
1488
1489 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1490 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1491 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001493
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001494 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
1495 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1496 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001497 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001498 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001499
John McCall23cba802010-03-30 23:58:03 +00001500 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
Douglas Gregor2d6b0e92010-05-22 05:17:18 +00001501 isLvalue, BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001502 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001503}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001504
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001505/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001506static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001507 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001508 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
1509 SourceLocation Loc, QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001510 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1511 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1512 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001513 if (SS.isSet()) {
1514 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1515 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001516 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001517
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001518 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001519 Member, FoundDecl, Loc, TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001520}
1521
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001522/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1523/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1524/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1525/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001526Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1528 LookupResult &R,
1529 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1530 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001531 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1532
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001533 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001534
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001535 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1536 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001537 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001538 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001539 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001540 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001541 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001542
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001543 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1544 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001545 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1546 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001547 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1548 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001549 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1550 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1551 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1552 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001553 }
1554
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001555 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, This), ThisType,
1556 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1557 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001558 SS,
1559 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1560 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001561}
1562
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001563bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001564 const LookupResult &R,
1565 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001566 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1567 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1568 return false;
1569
1570 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001571 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001572 return false;
1573
1574 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001575 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001576 return false;
1577
1578 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1579 // normal lookup:
1580 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1581 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1582
1583 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1584 // -- a declaration of a class member
1585 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1586 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001587 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001588 return false;
1589
1590 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1591 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1592 // using-declaration
1593 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1594 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1595 // turn off ADL anyway).
1596 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1597 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1598 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1599 return false;
1600
1601 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1602 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1603 // template
1604 // And also for builtin functions.
1605 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1606 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1607
1608 // But also builtin functions.
1609 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1610 return false;
1611 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1612 return false;
1613 }
1614
1615 return true;
1616}
1617
1618
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001619/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1620/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1621/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1622/// will in fact be used.
1623static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1624 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1625 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1626 return true;
1627 }
1628
1629 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1630 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1631 return true;
1632 }
1633
1634 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1635 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1636 return true;
1637 }
1638
1639 return false;
1640}
1641
1642Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001643Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001644 LookupResult &R,
1645 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001646 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1647 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001648 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001650
1651 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1652 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1653 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001654 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1655 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001656 return ExprError();
1657
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001658 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1659 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1660 // we've picked a target.
1661 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1662
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663 bool Dependent
1664 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001665 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001666 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001667 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
1668 SS.getRange(),
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001669 R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001670 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1671 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001672
1673 return Owned(ULE);
1674}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001675
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001676
1677/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
1678Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001679Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001680 SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1681 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001682 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1683 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684
1685 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1686 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001687
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001688 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1689 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1690 // a template argument list.
1691 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1692 << Template << SS.getRange();
1693 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1694 return ExprError();
1695 }
1696
1697 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1698 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1699 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001700 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001701 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001702 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001703 return ExprError();
1704 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001705
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001706 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1707 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1708 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1709 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001710 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001711 return ExprError();
1712
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001713 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1714 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001715 return ExprError();
1716
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001717 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1718 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1719 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1720 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001721 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001722 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1723 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1724 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001725 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001726 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001727 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1728 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1729 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1730 return ExprError();
1731 }
1732
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001733 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001734 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1735 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1736 return ExprError();
1737 }
1738
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001739 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001740 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001741 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001742 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001743 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001744 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1745 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001746 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001747
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001748 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001749 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1750 ExprTy, Loc, false,
1751 constAdded);
1752 QualType T = VD->getType();
1753 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !T->isDependentType() &&
1754 !T->isReferenceType()) {
1755 Expr *E = new (Context)
1756 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1757 SourceLocation());
1758
1759 OwningExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001760 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
1761 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001762 SourceLocation(),
1763 Owned(E));
1764 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001765 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(move(Res));
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001766 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1767 if (isa<CXXConstructExpr>(Init))
1768 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1769 }
1770 }
1771 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001772 }
1773 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1774 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001775
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001776 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(), Loc, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001777}
1778
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001779Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
1780 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001781 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001782
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001783 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001784 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001785 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1786 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1787 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001788 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001789
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001790 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1791 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001792
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001793 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
1794 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001795 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001796 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001797 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001798
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001799 QualType ResTy;
1800 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1801 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1802 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001803 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001804
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001805 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001806 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001807 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1808 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001809 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001810}
1811
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001812Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001813 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001814 bool Invalid = false;
1815 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1816 if (Invalid)
1817 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001818
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001819 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1820 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001821 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001822 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001823
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001824 QualType Ty;
1825 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1826 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1827 else if (Literal.isWide())
1828 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001829 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1830 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001831 else
1832 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001833
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001834 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1835 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001836 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001837}
1838
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001839Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
1840 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001841 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1842 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001843 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001844 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001845 return Owned(new (Context) IntegerLiteral(llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001846 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001847 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001848
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001849 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001850 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1851 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001852 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001853
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001854 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001855 bool Invalid = false;
1856 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1857 if (Invalid)
1858 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001859
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001860 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001861 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1862 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001863 return ExprError();
1864
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001865 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001866
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001867 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001868 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001869 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001870 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001871 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001872 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001873 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001874 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001875
1876 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1877
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001878 using llvm::APFloat;
1879 APFloat Val(Format);
1880
1881 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001882
1883 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1884 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1885 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1886 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001887 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001888 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001889 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001890 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001891 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
1892 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00001893 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001894 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
1895 }
1896
1897 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
1898 << Ty
1899 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
1900 }
1901
1902 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Chris Lattner001d64d2009-06-29 17:34:55 +00001903 Res = new (Context) FloatingLiteral(Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001904
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001905 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001906 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001907 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001908 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001909
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001910 // long long is a C99 feature.
1911 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00001912 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00001913 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
1914
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001915 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001916 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001917
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001918 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
1919 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
1920 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001921 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
1922 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001923 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001924 } else {
1925 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
1926 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001927
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001928 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
1929 // be an unsigned int.
1930 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
1931
1932 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001933 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00001934 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
1935 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001936 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001937
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001938 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
1939 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
1940 // Does it fit in a signed int?
1941 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001942 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001943 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001944 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001945 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001946 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001947 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001948
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001949 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001950 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001951 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001952
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001953 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
1954 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
1955 // Does it fit in a signed long?
1956 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001957 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001958 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001959 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001960 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001961 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001962 }
1963
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001964 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001965 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001966 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001967
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001968 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
1969 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
1970 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
1971 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001972 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001973 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001974 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001975 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001976 }
1977 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001978
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001979 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
1980 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001981 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001982 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00001983 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001984 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001985 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001986
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00001987 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
1988 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001989 }
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001990 Res = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001991 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001992
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001993 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
1994 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001995 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001996 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001997
1998 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001999}
2000
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002001Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
2002 SourceLocation R, ExprArg Val) {
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00002003 Expr *E = Val.takeAs<Expr>();
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002004 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002005 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002006}
2007
2008/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2009/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002010bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002011 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2012 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2013 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002014 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2015 return false;
2016
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002017 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2018 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2019 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2020 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2021 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2022 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2023
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002024 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002025 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002026 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002027 if (isSizeof)
2028 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2029 return false;
2030 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002031
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002032 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002033 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002034 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2035 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002036 return false;
2037 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002038
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002039 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002040 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2041 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002042 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002043
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002044 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002045 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002046 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002047 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2048 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002049 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002050
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002051 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2052 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2053 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2054 return true;
2055 }
2056
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002057 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002058}
2059
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002060bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2061 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2062 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002063
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002064 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002065 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2066 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002067
2068 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2069 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2070 return false;
2071
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002072 if (E->getBitField()) {
2073 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2074 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002075 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002076
2077 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2078 // bit-field.
2079 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002080 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002081 return false;
2082
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002083 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2084}
2085
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002086/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002087Action::OwningExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002088Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002089 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002090 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002091 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002092 return ExprError();
2093
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002094 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002095
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002096 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2097 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2098 return ExprError();
2099
2100 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002101 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002102 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2103 R.getEnd()));
2104}
2105
2106/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2107/// operand.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002108Action::OwningExprResult
2109Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002110 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2111 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2112 bool isInvalid = false;
2113 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2114 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2115 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2116 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002117 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002118 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2119 isInvalid = true;
2120 } else {
2121 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2122 }
2123
2124 if (isInvalid)
2125 return ExprError();
2126
2127 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2128 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2129 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2130 R.getEnd()));
2131}
2132
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002133/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2134/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2135/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002136Action::OwningExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002137Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2138 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002139 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002140 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002141
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002142 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002143 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
2144 (void) GetTypeFromParser(TyOrEx, &TInfo);
2145 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002146 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002147
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002148 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
2149 Action::OwningExprResult Result
2150 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2151
2152 if (Result.isInvalid())
2153 DeleteExpr(ArgEx);
2154
2155 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002156}
2157
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002158QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002159 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2160 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002161
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002162 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002163 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002164 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002165
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002166 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2167 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2168 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002169
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002170 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002171 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2172 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002173 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002174}
2175
2176
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002177
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002178Action::OwningExprResult
2179Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2180 tok::TokenKind Kind, ExprArg Input) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002181 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
2182 switch (Kind) {
2183 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
2184 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostInc; break;
2185 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PostDec; break;
2186 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002187
Eli Friedmane4216e92009-11-18 03:38:04 +00002188 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, move(Input));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002189}
2190
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002191Action::OwningExprResult
2192Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2193 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002194 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
2195 Base = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Base));
2196
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002197 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
2198 *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002199
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002200 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002201 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
2202 Base.release();
2203 Idx.release();
2204 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2205 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2206 }
2207
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002208 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002209 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002210 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2211 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2212 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002213 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, move(Base),move(Idx));
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002214 }
2215
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002216 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(move(Base), LLoc, move(Idx), RLoc);
2217}
2218
2219
2220Action::OwningExprResult
2221Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(ExprArg Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2222 ExprArg Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2223 Expr *LHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get());
2224 Expr *RHSExp = static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get());
2225
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002226 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002227 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2228 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2229 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002230
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002231 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002232
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002233 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002234 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002235 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002236 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002237 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2238 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002239 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2240 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2241 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2242 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002243 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002244 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2245 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002246 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002247 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002248 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002249 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2250 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002251 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002252 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002253 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002254 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2255 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2256 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002257 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002258 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002259 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2260 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2261 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2262 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002263 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002264 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002265 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002266
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002267 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2268 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002269 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2270 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002271 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002272 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2273 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2274 // force the promotion here.
2275 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2276 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002277 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
2278 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002279 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2280
2281 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2282 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002283 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002284 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2285 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2286 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2287 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002288 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
2289 CastExpr::CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002290 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2291
2292 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2293 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002294 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002295 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002296 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2297 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002298 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002299 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002300 if (!(IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
2301 IndexExpr->getType()->isScalarType()) && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002302 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2303 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002304
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002305 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002306 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2307 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002308 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2309
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002310 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002311 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2312 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002313 // incomplete types are not object types.
2314 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2315 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2316 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2317 return ExprError();
2318 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002319
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002320 if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002321 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002322 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2323 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002324 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002325
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002326 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002327 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002328 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2329 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2330 return ExprError();
2331 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002332
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002333 Base.release();
2334 Idx.release();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002335 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002336 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002337}
2338
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002339QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002340CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002341 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002342 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002343 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2344 // see FIXME there.
2345 //
2346 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2347 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002348 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002349
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002350 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002351 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002352
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002353 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002354 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2355 // to be selected.
2356 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002357
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002358 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2359 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002360 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002361
2362 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2363 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002364 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002365 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2366 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002367 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002368 do
2369 compStr++;
2370 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002371 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002372 do
2373 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002374 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002375 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002376
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002377 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002378 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2379 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002380 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
2381 << std::string(compStr,compStr+1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002382 return QualType();
2383 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002384
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002385 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2386 // operates on.
2387 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002388 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002389
2390 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002391 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002392
2393 while (*compStr) {
2394 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2395 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2396 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2397 return QualType();
2398 }
2399 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002400 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002401
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002402 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002403 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002404 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002405 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002406 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002407 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002408 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002409 if (HexSwizzle)
2410 CompSize--;
2411
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002412 if (CompSize == 1)
2413 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002414
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002415 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002416 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002417 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2418 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2419 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2420 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002421 }
2422 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002423}
2424
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002425static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002426 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002427 const Selector &Sel,
2428 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002429
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002430 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002431 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002432 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002433 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002434
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002435 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2436 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002437 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002438 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002439 return D;
2440 }
2441 return 0;
2442}
2443
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002444static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002445 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002446 const Selector &Sel,
2447 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002448 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2449 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002450 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002451 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002452 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002453 GDecl = PD;
2454 break;
2455 }
2456 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002457 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002458 GDecl = OMD;
2459 break;
2460 }
2461 }
2462 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002463 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002464 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2465 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002466 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002467 if (GDecl)
2468 return GDecl;
2469 }
2470 }
2471 return GDecl;
2472}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002473
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002474Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002475Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseType,
2476 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002477 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2478 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2479 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2480 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2481 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
2482
2483 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2484 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2485 //
2486 // T* t;
2487 // t.f;
2488 //
2489 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2490 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2491 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2492 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002493 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002494 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2495 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002496 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002497 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002498 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002499 return ExprError();
2500 }
2501 }
2502
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002503 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002504 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002505
2506 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2507 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002508 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002509 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2510 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep()),
2511 SS.getRange(),
2512 FirstQualifierInScope,
2513 Name, NameLoc,
2514 TemplateArgs));
2515}
2516
2517/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2518/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2519/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2520static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2521 Expr *BaseExpr,
2522 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002523 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002524 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002525 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2526 // diagnostics.
2527 if (!BaseExpr)
2528 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002529
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002530 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2531 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002532}
2533
2534// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2535// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2536// type. The restriction here is:
2537//
2538// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2539// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2540// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2541//
2542// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2543// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2544// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2545// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2546bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2547 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002548 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002549 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002550 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2551 if (!BaseRT) {
2552 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2553 // dependent.
2554 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2555 return false;
2556 }
2557 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002558
2559 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002560 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2561 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002562 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002563 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002564
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002565 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
2566 CXXRecordDecl *RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>((*I)->getDeclContext());
2567 while (RecordD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
2568 RecordD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordD->getParent());
2569
2570 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
2571 MemberRecord.insert(RecordD->getCanonicalDecl());
2572
2573 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2574 return false;
2575 }
2576
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002577 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002578 return true;
2579}
2580
2581static bool
2582LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2583 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002584 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002585 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2586 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002587 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002588 << BaseRange))
2589 return true;
2590
2591 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2592 if (SS.isSet()) {
2593 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2594 // nested-name-specifier.
2595 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2596
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002597 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002598 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2599 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2600 return true;
2601 }
2602
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002603 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002604
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002605 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2606 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2607 << DC << SS.getRange();
2608 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002609 }
2610 }
2611
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002612 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2613 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002614
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002615 if (!R.empty())
2616 return false;
2617
2618 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2619 // for typos.
2620 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002621 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002622 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002623 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2624 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2625 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002626 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2627 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002628 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2629 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2630 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002631 return false;
2632 } else {
2633 R.clear();
2634 }
2635
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002636 return false;
2637}
2638
2639Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002640Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg BaseArg, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002641 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002642 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002643 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
2644 DeclarationName Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
2645 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2646 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
2647
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002648 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2649 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002650 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002651 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2652 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2653 Name, NameLoc,
2654 TemplateArgs);
2655
2656 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002657
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002658 // Implicit member accesses.
2659 if (!Base) {
2660 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2661 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2662 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2663 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
2664 OpLoc, SS))
2665 return ExprError();
2666
2667 // Explicit member accesses.
2668 } else {
2669 OwningExprResult Result =
2670 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002671 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ DeclPtrTy());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002672
2673 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2674 Owned(Base);
2675 return ExprError();
2676 }
2677
2678 if (Result.get())
2679 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002680
2681 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2682 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002683 }
2684
Sebastian Redl0aa866f2010-05-07 09:09:23 +00002685 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002686 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2687 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002688}
2689
2690Sema::OwningExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002691Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg Base, QualType BaseExprType,
2692 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2693 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002694 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002695 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002696 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2697 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002698 Expr *BaseExpr = Base.takeAs<Expr>();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002699 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002700 if (IsArrow) {
2701 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2702 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2703 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002704 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002705
2706 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier =
2707 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep());
2708 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2709 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
2710
2711 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002712 return ExprError();
2713
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002714 if (R.empty()) {
2715 // Rederive where we looked up.
2716 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2717 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2718 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002719
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002720 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002721 << MemberName << DC
2722 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002723 return ExprError();
2724 }
2725
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002726 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2727 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2728 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2729 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2730 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2731 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2732 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2733 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2734 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2735 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002736 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002737 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002738 return ExprError();
2739
2740 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2741 // result.
2742 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002743 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002744 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002745 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002746 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002747
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002748 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2749 // pick a member.
2750 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2751
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002752 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2753 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2754 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002755 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2756 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002757 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
2758 MemberName, MemberLoc,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002759 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002760
2761 return Owned(MemExpr);
2762 }
2763
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002764 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002765 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002766 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2767
2768 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2769
2770 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2771 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2772 // error cases.
2773 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2774 return ExprError();
2775
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002776 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2777 if (!BaseExpr) {
2778 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002779 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002780 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getNameLoc(), MemberDecl);
2781
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002782 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2783 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2784 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2785 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002786 }
2787
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002788 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2789 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2790 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2791 // explicitly qualified.
2792 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2793 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2794 }
2795
2796 // Check the use of this member.
2797 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2798 Owned(BaseExpr);
2799 return ExprError();
2800 }
2801
2802 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2803 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2804 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002805 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2806 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002807 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2808 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2809
2810 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2811 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2812 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2813 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2814 else {
2815 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2816 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2817 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2818
2819 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2820 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2821
2822 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2823 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2824 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2825 }
2826
2827 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002828 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002829 return ExprError();
2830 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002831 FD, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002832 }
2833
2834 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2835 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2836 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002837 Var, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002838 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2839 }
2840
2841 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2842 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2843 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002844 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002845 MemberFn->getType()));
2846 }
2847
2848 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2849 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2850 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002851 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberLoc, Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002852 }
2853
2854 Owned(BaseExpr);
2855
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002856 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002857 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002858 Diag(MemberLoc,diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
2859 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2860 else
2861 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2862 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002863
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002864 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2865 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002866 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002867 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002868}
2869
2870/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2871/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2872/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2873/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2874/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2875/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2876/// an ordinary member expression.
2877///
2878/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2879/// fixed for ObjC++.
2880Sema::OwningExprResult
2881Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00002882 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002883 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002884 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00002885 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002886
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00002887 // Perform default conversions.
2888 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002889
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002890 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002891 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
2892
2893 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
2894 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002895
2896 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002897 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002898 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
2899 // call, and continue on.
2900 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2901 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
2902 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
2903 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
2904 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002905 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
2906 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002907 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
2908 ->isRecordType()))) {
2909 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
2910 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
2911 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002912 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002913
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002914 OwningExprResult NewBase
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002915 = ActOnCallExpr(0, ExprArg(*this, BaseExpr), Loc,
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002916 MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), 0, Loc);
2917 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002918 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002919
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00002920 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
2921 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
2922 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
2923 }
2924 }
2925 }
2926
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002927 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2928 // use that.
2929 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002930 if (IsArrow) {
2931 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
2932 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
2933 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002934 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002935 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00002936 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
2937 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00002938 }
2939 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002940 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2941 // is a reference to 'isa'.
2942 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
2943 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002944 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002945 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00002946 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002947
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00002948 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
2949 // use that.
2950 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
2951 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
2952 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
2953 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
2954 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
2955 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
2956 }
2957 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002958
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00002959 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002960
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002961 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002962 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002963 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
2964 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2965 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
2966 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
2967 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
2968 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
2969 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
2970 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
2971 // Check the use of this method.
2972 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
2973 return ExprError();
2974 }
2975 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
2976 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
2977 Selector SetterSel =
2978 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
2979 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
2980 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
2981 if (!Setter) {
2982 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
2983 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00002984 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002985 }
2986 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
2987 if (!Setter)
2988 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002989
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002990 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
2991 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002992
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002993 if (Getter || Setter) {
2994 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002995
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00002996 if (Getter)
2997 PType = Getter->getResultType();
2998 else
2999 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3000 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3001 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003002 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003003 PType,
3004 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3005 }
3006 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3007 << MemberName << BaseType);
3008 }
3009 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003010
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003011 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3012 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3013 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003014 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003015 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003016
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003017 if (IsArrow) {
3018 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003019 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003020 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3021 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003022 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3023 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3024 // struct MyRecord foo;
3025 // foo->bar
3026 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3027 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3028 // by now.
3029 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3030 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003031 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003032 IsArrow = false;
3033 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003034 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3035 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3036 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003037 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003038 } else {
3039 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3040 // type *foo;
3041 // foo.bar
3042 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3043 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3044 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3045 // the appropriate pointer type
3046 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3047 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3048 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3049 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3050 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003051 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003052 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3053 IsArrow = true;
3054 }
3055 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003056 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003057
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003058 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003059 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003060 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
3061 RTy, OpLoc, SS))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003062 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003063 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003064 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003065
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003066 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3067 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003068 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003069 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003070 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003071 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3072 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3073 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3074 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003075 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3076
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003077 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003078 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003079
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003080 if (!IV) {
3081 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3082 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3083 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003084 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003085 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003086 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003087 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3088 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003089 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3090 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003091 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003092 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003093 }
3094 }
3095
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003096 if (IV) {
3097 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3098 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3099 // error cases.
3100 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3101 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003102
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003103 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3104 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3105 return ExprError();
3106 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3107 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3108 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3109 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3110 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3111 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3112 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3113 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3114 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3115 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3116 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3117 // AST for a function decl.
3118 Decl *ImplDecl = ObjCImpDecl.getAs<Decl>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003119 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003120 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ImplDecl))
3121 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3122 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
3123 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ImplDecl))
3124 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3125 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003126
3127 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3128 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003129 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003130 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003131 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003132 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3133 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003134 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003135 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003136 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003137
3138 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3139 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003140 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003141 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003142 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003143 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003144 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003145 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003146 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003147 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003148 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3149 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003150 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003151 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003152
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003153 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003154 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003155 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3156 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3157 // Check the use of this declaration
3158 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3159 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003160
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003161 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3162 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3163 }
3164 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3165 // Check the use of this method.
3166 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3167 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003168
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003169 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003170 OMD->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
3171 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3172 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003173 }
3174 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003175
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003176 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003177 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003178 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003179
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003180 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3181 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003182 if (!IsArrow)
3183 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3184 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003185 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003186
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003187 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003188 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003189 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3190 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003191 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003192 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003193 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003194
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003195 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003196 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003197 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003198 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3199 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003200 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003201 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003202 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003203 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003204
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003205 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3206 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3207
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003208 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003209}
3210
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003211/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3212/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3213/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3214/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3215/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3216///
3217/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3218/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3219/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3220/// only be called
3221/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3222/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3223/// aren't properly put in the context chain
3224Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseArg,
3225 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3226 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003227 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003228 UnqualifiedId &Id,
3229 DeclPtrTy ObjCImpDecl,
3230 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3231 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3232 return ExprError();
3233
3234 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3235
3236 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
3237 DeclarationName Name;
3238 SourceLocation NameLoc;
3239 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3240 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
3241 Name, NameLoc, TemplateArgs);
3242
3243 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3244
3245 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3246 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3247 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3248
3249 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
3250 BaseArg = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(BaseArg));
3251
3252 Expr *Base = BaseArg.takeAs<Expr>();
3253 OwningExprResult Result(*this);
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003254 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3255 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003256 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003257 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3258 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3259 Name, NameLoc,
3260 TemplateArgs);
3261 } else {
3262 LookupResult R(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupMemberName);
3263 if (TemplateArgs) {
3264 // Re-use the lookup done for the template name.
3265 DecomposeTemplateName(R, Id);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003266
Douglas Gregorc96be1e2010-04-27 18:19:34 +00003267 // Re-derive the naming class.
3268 if (SS.isSet()) {
3269 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier
3270 = static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier *>(SS.getScopeRep());
3271 if (const Type *Ty = Qualifier->getAsType())
3272 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3273 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3274 } else {
3275 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
3276 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
3277 BaseType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
3278 if (CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = BaseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3279 R.setNamingClass(NamingClass);
3280 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003281 } else {
3282 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003283 SS, ObjCImpDecl);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003284
3285 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3286 Owned(Base);
3287 return ExprError();
3288 }
3289
3290 if (Result.get()) {
3291 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3292 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3293 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3294 // call now.
3295 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3296 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
Douglas Gregor77549082010-02-24 21:29:12 +00003297 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameLoc, move(Result));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003298
3299 return move(Result);
3300 }
3301 }
3302
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003303 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(ExprArg(*this, Base), Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003304 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3305 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003306 }
3307
3308 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003309}
3310
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003311Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3312 FunctionDecl *FD,
3313 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3314 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
3315 Diag (CallLoc,
3316 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3317 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003318 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003319 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
3320 } else {
3321 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3322 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
3323
3324 // Instantiate the expression.
Douglas Gregor525f96c2010-02-05 07:33:43 +00003325 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3326 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003327
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003328 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
3329 ArgList.getInnermost().getFlatArgumentList(),
Douglas Gregord6350ae2009-08-28 20:31:08 +00003330 ArgList.getInnermost().flat_size());
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003331
John McCallce3ff2b2009-08-25 22:02:44 +00003332 OwningExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003333 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003334 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003335
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003336 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3337 InitializedEntity Entity
3338 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param);
3339 InitializationKind Kind
3340 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3341 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3342 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
3343
3344 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003345 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003346 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&ResultE, 1));
3347 if (Result.isInvalid())
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003348 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003349
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003350 // Build the default argument expression.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003351 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003352 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003353 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003354
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003355 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3356 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3357 // be properly destroyed.
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003358 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3359 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Anders Carlsson337cba42009-12-15 19:16:31 +00003360 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i)
3361 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003362 }
3363
3364 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003365 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003366}
3367
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003368/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3369/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3370/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3371/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3372/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3373/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003374bool
3375Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003376 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003377 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003378 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3379 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003380 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003381 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3382 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003383 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003384
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003385 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3386 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3387 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3388 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3389 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003390 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003391 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003392 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003393 }
3394
3395 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3396 // them.
3397 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3398 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3399 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3400 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003401 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003402 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003403 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3404 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3405 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003406 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003407 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003408 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003409 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003410 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003411 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003412 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3413 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3414 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3415 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3416 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003417 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003418 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003419 if (Invalid)
3420 return true;
3421 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3422 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3423 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003424
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003425 return false;
3426}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003427
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003428bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3429 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3430 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3431 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3432 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3433 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003434 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003435 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3436 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3437 bool Invalid = false;
3438 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3439 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3440 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3441 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003442 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003443 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003444 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003445
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003446 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003447 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3448 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003449
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003450 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3451 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003452 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003453 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003454 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003455
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003456 // Pass the argument
3457 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3458 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3459 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003460
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003461
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003462 InitializedEntity Entity =
3463 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Param)
3464 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(ProtoArgType);
3465 OwningExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
3466 SourceLocation(),
3467 Owned(Arg));
3468 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3469 return true;
3470
3471 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003472 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003473 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003474
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003475 OwningExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003476 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003477 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3478 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003479
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003480 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003481 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003482 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003483 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003484
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003485 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003486 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003487 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003488 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003489 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003490 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003491 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003492 }
3493 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003494 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003495}
3496
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003497/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003498/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3499/// locations.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003500Action::OwningExprResult
3501Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3502 MultiExprArg args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003503 SourceLocation *CommaLocs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003504 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003505
3506 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3507 fn = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(fn));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003508
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00003509 Expr *Fn = fn.takeAs<Expr>();
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003510 Expr **Args = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(args.release());
Chris Lattner74c469f2007-07-21 03:03:59 +00003511 assert(Fn && "no function call expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003512
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003513 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003514 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3515 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3516 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3517 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3518 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003519 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003520 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3521 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003522
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003523 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3524 Args[I]->Destroy(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003525
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003526 NumArgs = 0;
3527 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003528
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003529 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3530 RParenLoc));
3531 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003532
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003533 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003534 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003535 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3536 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003537 bool Dependent = false;
3538 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3539 Dependent = true;
3540 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3541 Dependent = true;
3542
3543 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003544 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003545 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3546
3547 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3548 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3549 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3550 CommaLocs, RParenLoc));
3551
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003552 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3553
3554 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3555 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3556 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3557 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3558 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3559 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3560 // method template.
3561 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003562 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3563 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003564 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003565
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003566 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3567 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003568 }
3569
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003570 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003571 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003572 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003573 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003574 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
3575 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003576 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003577
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003578 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003579 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003580 if (BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD ||
3581 BO->getOpcode() == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003582 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3583 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003584 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003585
3586 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
3587 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003588 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3589 RParenLoc));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003590
3591 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3592 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003593 TheCall.get(), 0))
3594 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003595
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003596 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003597 RParenLoc))
3598 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003599
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003600 return Owned(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).release());
3601 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003602 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003603 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3604 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003605 }
3606 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003607 }
3608
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003609 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003610 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003611 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003612
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003613 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003614 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3615 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003616 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003617 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003618 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003619
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003620 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3621 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3622 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3623
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003624 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3625}
3626
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003627/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3628/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003629/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3630/// block-pointer type.
3631///
3632/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
3633Sema::OwningExprResult
3634Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3635 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3636 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3637 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3638 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3639
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003640 // Promote the function operand.
3641 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3642
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003643 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3644 // of arguments and function on error.
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003645 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this, new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3646 Args, NumArgs,
3647 Context.BoolTy,
3648 RParenLoc));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003649
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003650 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3651 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3652 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3653 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003654 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003655 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003656 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3657 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003658 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003659 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003660 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003661 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003662 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003663 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003664 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3665 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3666
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003667 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003668 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003669 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall.get(),
3670 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003671 return ExprError();
3672
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003673 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +00003674 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getResultType().getNonReferenceType());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003675
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003676 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003677 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003678 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003679 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003680 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003681 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003682
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003683 if (FDecl) {
3684 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3685 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3686 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6fb0aee2009-06-30 02:35:26 +00003687 if (FDecl->getBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003688 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003689 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003690 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3691 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3692 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3693 }
3694 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003695 }
3696
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003697 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003698 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3699 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3700 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003701 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3702 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003703 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3704 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003705 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003706 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003707 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003708 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003709
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003710 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3711 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003712 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3713 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003714
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003715 // Check for sentinels
3716 if (NDecl)
3717 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003718
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003719 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003720 if (FDecl) {
3721 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall.get()))
3722 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003723
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003724 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003725 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall.take());
3726 } else if (NDecl) {
3727 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall.get()))
3728 return ExprError();
3729 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003730
Anders Carlssonec74c592009-08-16 03:06:32 +00003731 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.take());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003732}
3733
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003734Action::OwningExprResult
3735Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
3736 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003737 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003738 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003739 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003740
3741 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3742 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3743 if (!TInfo)
3744 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3745
3746 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(InitExpr));
3747}
3748
3749Action::OwningExprResult
3750Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3751 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg InitExpr) {
3752 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003753 Expr *literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(InitExpr.get());
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003754
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003755 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003756 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003757 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3758 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003759 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3760 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003761 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003762 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003763 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003764 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003765
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003766 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003767 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003768 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003769 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003770 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003771 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
3772 OwningExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3773 MultiExprArg(*this, (void**)&literalExpr, 1),
3774 &literalType);
3775 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003776 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003777 InitExpr.release();
3778 literalExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Result.get());
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003779
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003780 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003781 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003782 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003783 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003784 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003785
3786 Result.release();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003787
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003788 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003789 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003790}
3791
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003792Action::OwningExprResult
3793Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003794 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3795 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
3796 Expr **InitList = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(initlist.release());
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003797
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003798 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003799 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003800
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003801 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3802 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003803 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003804 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003805}
3806
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003807static CastExpr::CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
3808 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003809 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003810 return CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
3811
3812 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3813 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003814 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
3815 CastExpr::CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
Fariborz Jahaniana7fa7cd2009-12-15 21:34:52 +00003816 CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003817 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3818 return CastExpr::CK_PointerToIntegral;
3819 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003820
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003821 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3822 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3823 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast;
3824 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
3825 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer;
3826 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3827 return CastExpr::CK_IntegralToFloating;
3828 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003829
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003830 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3831 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
3832 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast;
3833 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
3834 return CastExpr::CK_FloatingToIntegral;
3835 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003836
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003837 // FIXME: Assert here.
3838 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
3839 return CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
3840}
3841
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003842/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003843bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003844 CastExpr::CastKind& Kind,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003845 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003846 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003847 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003848 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3849 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003850
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003851 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003852
3853 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3854 // type needs to be scalar.
3855 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3856 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003857 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToVoid;
3858 return false;
3859 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003860
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003861 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003862 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003863 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3864 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003865 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003866 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3867 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003868 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003869 return false;
3870 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003871
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003872 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003873 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003874 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003875 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003876 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003877 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003878 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003879 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003880 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3881 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3882 break;
3883 }
3884 }
3885 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3886 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3887 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson4d8673b2009-08-07 23:22:37 +00003888 Kind = CastExpr::CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003889 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003890 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003891
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003892 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3893 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3894 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3895 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003896
3897 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003898 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003899 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3900 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003901 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003902 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003903
3904 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003905 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003906
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003907 if (castType->isVectorType())
3908 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
3909 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
3910 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
3911
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003912 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
3913 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003914
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003915 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00003916 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
3917 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType() && castExprType->isArithmeticType())
3918 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3919 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
3920 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3921 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
3922 if (!castType->isIntegralType() && castType->isArithmeticType())
3923 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
3924 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
3925 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003926 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003927
3928 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003929 return false;
3930}
3931
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003932bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
3933 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003934 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003935
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003936 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00003937 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003938 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003939 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003940 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003941 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003942 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003943 } else
3944 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003945 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00003946 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003947
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003948 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00003949 return false;
3950}
3951
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003952bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003953 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003954 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003955
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003956 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003957
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00003958 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
3959 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003960 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
3961 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
3962 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
3963 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003964 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003965 return false;
3966 }
3967
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003968 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003969 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
3970 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00003971 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
3972 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
3973 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
3974 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003975
3976 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
3977 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
3978 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003979
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00003980 Kind = CastExpr::CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00003981 return false;
3982}
3983
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003984Action::OwningExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003985Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeTy *Ty,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003986 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
3987 assert((Ty != 0) && (Op.get() != 0) &&
3988 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00003989
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00003990 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
3991 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
3992 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003993 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003994
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003995 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00003996 Expr *castExpr = (Expr *)Op.get();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003997 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003998 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, move(Op),
3999 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004000
4001 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
4002}
4003
4004Action::OwningExprResult
4005Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
4006 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op) {
4007 Expr *castExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(Op.get());
4008
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004009 CastExpr::CastKind Kind = CastExpr::CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004010 CXXBaseSpecifierArray BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004011 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004012 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004013 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004014
Douglas Gregord6e44a32010-04-16 22:09:46 +00004015 Op.release();
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004016 return Owned(new (Context) CStyleCastExpr(Ty->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
Anders Carlsson41b2dcd2010-04-24 18:38:56 +00004017 Kind, castExpr, BasePath, Ty,
Anders Carlssoncdb61972009-08-07 22:21:05 +00004018 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004019}
4020
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004021/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4022/// of comma binary operators.
4023Action::OwningExprResult
4024Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg EA) {
4025 Expr *expr = EA.takeAs<Expr>();
4026 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4027 if (!E)
4028 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004029
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004030 OwningExprResult Result(*this, E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004031
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004032 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
4033 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, move(Result),
4034 Owned(E->getExpr(i)));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004035
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004036 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), move(Result));
4037}
4038
4039Action::OwningExprResult
4040Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4041 SourceLocation RParenLoc, ExprArg Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004042 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004043 ParenListExpr *PE = (ParenListExpr *)Op.get();
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004044 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004045
4046 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004047 // then handle it as such.
4048 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4049 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4050 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4051 return ExprError();
4052 }
4053
4054 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4055 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4056 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4057
4058 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4059 // braces instead of the original commas.
4060 Op.release();
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004061 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4062 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004063 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4064 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004065 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Owned(E));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004066 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004067 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004068 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
4069 Op = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, move(Op));
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004070 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, move(Op));
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004071 }
4072}
4073
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004074Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004075 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004076 MultiExprArg Val,
4077 TypeTy *TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004078 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4079 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004080 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4081 Expr *expr;
4082 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4083 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4084 else
4085 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004086 return Owned(expr);
4087}
4088
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004089/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4090/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004091/// C99 6.5.15
4092QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4093 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004094 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4095 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
4096 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
4097
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004098 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
4099 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
4100 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4101 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4102 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4103 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004104
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004105 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004106 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
4107 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4108 << CondTy;
4109 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004110 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004111
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004112 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004113 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4114 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004115
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004116 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4117 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004118 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4119 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4120 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004121 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004122
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004123 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4124 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004125 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4126 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004127 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004128 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004129 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004130 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004131 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004132 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004133
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004134 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004135 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004136 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4137 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4138 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4139 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4140 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4141 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4142 << LHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004143 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
4144 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CastExpr::CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004145 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004146 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004147 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4148 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004149 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004150 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004151 // promote the null to a pointer.
4152 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004153 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004154 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004155 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004156 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004157 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004158 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004159 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004160
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004161 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4162 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4163 QuestionLoc);
4164 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4165 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004166
4167
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004168 // Handle block pointer types.
4169 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4170 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4171 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4172 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004173 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4174 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004175 return destType;
4176 }
4177 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004178 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004179 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004180 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004181 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4182 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4183 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004184 return LHSTy;
4185 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004186 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004187 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4188 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004189
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004190 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4191 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004192 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004193 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004194 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4195 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4196 // to get a consistent AST.
4197 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004198 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4199 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004200 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004201 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004202 // The block pointer types are compatible.
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004203 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4204 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004205 return LHSTy;
4206 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004207
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004208 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4209 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4210 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004211 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4212 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004213
4214 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4215 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4216 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004217 QualType destPointee
4218 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004219 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004220 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4221 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4222 // Promote to void*.
4223 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004224 return destType;
4225 }
4226 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004227 QualType destPointee
4228 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004229 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004230 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004231 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004232 // Promote to void*.
Eli Friedman16fea9b2009-11-17 01:22:05 +00004233 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004234 return destType;
4235 }
4236
4237 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4238 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4239 return LHSTy;
4240 }
4241 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4242 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4243 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4244 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4245 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4246 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4247 // to get a consistent AST.
4248 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004249 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4250 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004251 return incompatTy;
4252 }
4253 // The pointer types are compatible.
4254 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4255 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4256 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4257 // type.
4258 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4259 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004260 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4261 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004262 return LHSTy;
4263 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004264
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004265 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4266 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4267 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4268 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004269 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004270 return RHSTy;
4271 }
4272 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4273 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4274 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004275 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004276 return LHSTy;
4277 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004278
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004279 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004280 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4281 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004282 return QualType();
4283}
4284
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004285/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4286/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4287QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4288 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4289 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4290 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004291
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004292 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4293 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4294 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4295 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4296 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4297 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4298 return LHSTy;
4299 }
4300 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4301 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
4302 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4303 return RHSTy;
4304 }
4305 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4306 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4307 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4308 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4309 return LHSTy;
4310 }
4311 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4312 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
4313 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4314 return RHSTy;
4315 }
4316 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4317 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4318 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4319 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4320 return LHSTy;
4321 }
4322 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4323 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
4324 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4325 return RHSTy;
4326 }
4327 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4328 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004329
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004330 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4331 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4332 return LHSTy;
4333 }
4334 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4335 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4336 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004337
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004338 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4339 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4340 // type. This allows
4341 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4342 // where B is a subclass of A.
4343 //
4344 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4345 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4346 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4347 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004348
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004349 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4350 // It could return the composite type.
4351 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4352 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4353 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4354 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4355 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4356 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4357 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4358 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4359 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4360 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4361 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4362 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4363 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4364 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004365 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004366 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4367 ;
4368 else {
4369 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4370 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4371 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4372 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
4373 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4374 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4375 return incompatTy;
4376 }
4377 // The object pointer types are compatible.
4378 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4379 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4380 return compositeType;
4381 }
4382 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4383 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4384 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4385 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4386 QualType destPointee
4387 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4388 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4389 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4390 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4391 // Promote to void*.
4392 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4393 return destType;
4394 }
4395 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4396 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4397 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4398 QualType destPointee
4399 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4400 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4401 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
4402 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp);
4403 // Promote to void*.
4404 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4405 return destType;
4406 }
4407 return QualType();
4408}
4409
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004410/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004411/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004412Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
4413 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
4414 ExprArg Cond, ExprArg LHS,
4415 ExprArg RHS) {
4416 Expr *CondExpr = (Expr *) Cond.get();
4417 Expr *LHSExpr = (Expr *) LHS.get(), *RHSExpr = (Expr *) RHS.get();
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004418
4419 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4420 // was the condition.
4421 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
4422 if (isLHSNull)
4423 LHSExpr = CondExpr;
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004424
4425 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr,
Chris Lattner26824902007-07-16 21:39:03 +00004426 RHSExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004427 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004428 return ExprError();
4429
4430 Cond.release();
4431 LHS.release();
4432 RHS.release();
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004433 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004434 isLHSNull ? 0 : LHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004435 ColonLoc, RHSExpr, result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004436}
4437
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004438// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004439// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004440// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4441// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4442// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004443Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004444Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4445 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004446
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004447 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4448 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4449 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4450 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4451 return Compatible;
4452 }
4453
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004454 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004455 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4456 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004457
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004458 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004459 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4460 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004461
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004462 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004463
4464 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4465 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4466 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004467 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004468 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004469 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004470
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004471 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4472 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004473 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004474 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004475 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004476 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004477
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004478 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004479 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4480 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004481 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004482
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004483 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004484 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004485 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004486
4487 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004488 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4489 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004490 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004491 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004492 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004493 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4494 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4495 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4496 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4497 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4498 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004499 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004500 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004501 else if (lhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004502 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004503
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004504 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004505 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004506 else if (rhptee->isSignedIntegerType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004507 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004508
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004509 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4510 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4511 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4512 // warning can be disabled.
4513 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4514 return ConvTy;
4515 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4516 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004517
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004518 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4519 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4520 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4521 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4522 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4523 do {
4524 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4525 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004526
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004527 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4528 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4529 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004530
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004531 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004532 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004533 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004534
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004535 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004536 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004537 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004538 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004539}
4540
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004541/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4542/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4543/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4544// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004545Sema::AssignConvertType
4546Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004547 QualType rhsType) {
4548 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004549
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004550 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004551 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4552 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004553
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004554 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4555 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4556 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004557
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004558 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004559
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004560 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004561 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004562 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004563
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004564 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4565 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4566 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4567 }
4568 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004569 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004570 return ConvTy;
4571}
4572
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004573/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4574/// for assignment compatibility.
4575Sema::AssignConvertType
4576Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004577 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4578 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004579 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4580 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004581 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004582 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004583 }
4584 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4585 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004586 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4587 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004588 return IncompatiblePointer;
4589 return Compatible;
4590 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004591 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004592 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004593 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004594 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4595 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4596 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4597 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4598 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4599 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004600
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004601 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4602 return Compatible;
4603 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4604 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004605 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004606}
4607
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004608/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4609/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004610/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4611///
4612/// int a, *pint;
4613/// short *pshort;
4614/// struct foo *pfoo;
4615///
4616/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4617/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4618/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4619/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4620///
4621/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004622/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004623///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004624Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004625Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004626 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4627 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004628 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4629 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004630
4631 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004632 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004633
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004634 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4635 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4636 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4637 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4638 return Compatible;
4639 }
4640
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004641 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4642 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4643 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4644 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4645 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4646 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4647 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004648 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004649 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004650 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004651 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004652 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004653 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4654 // to the same ExtVector type.
4655 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4656 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4657 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
4658 if (!rhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType())
4659 return Compatible;
4660 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004661
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004662 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004663 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004664 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004665 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004666 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4667 lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004668 if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004669 return IncompatibleVectors;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004670 }
4671 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004672 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004673
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004674 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4675 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004676 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004677
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004678 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004679 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004680 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004681
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004682 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004683 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004684
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004685 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004686 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004687 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4688 return Compatible;
4689 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004690 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004691 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4692 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004693 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004694
4695 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004696 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004697 return Compatible;
4698 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004699 return Incompatible;
4700 }
4701
4702 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4703 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004704 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004705
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004706 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004707 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004708 return Compatible;
4709
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004710 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4711 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004712
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004713 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004714 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004715 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004716 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004717 return Incompatible;
4718 }
4719
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004720 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4721 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4722 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004723
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004724 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004725 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004726 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4727 return Compatible;
4728 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004729 }
4730 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004731 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004732 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004733 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004734 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4735 return Compatible;
4736 }
4737 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4738 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4739 return Compatible;
4740 return Incompatible;
4741 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004742 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004743 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004744 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4745 return Compatible;
4746
4747 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004748 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004749
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004750 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004751 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004752
4753 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004754 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004755 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004756 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004757 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004758 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4759 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4760 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4761 return Compatible;
4762
4763 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4764 return PointerToInt;
4765
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004766 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004767 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004768 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4769 return Compatible;
4770 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004771 }
4772 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004773 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004774 return Compatible;
4775 return Incompatible;
4776 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004777
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004778 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004779 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004780 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004781 }
4782 return Incompatible;
4783}
4784
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004785/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4786/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004787static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004788 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4789 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4790 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004791 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004792 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004793 SourceLocation());
4794 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4795 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4796
4797 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4798 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004799 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004800 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004801 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004802}
4803
4804Sema::AssignConvertType
4805Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4806 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4807
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004808 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004809 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4810 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004811 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004812 return Incompatible;
4813
4814 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4815 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4816 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4817 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004818 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4819 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004820 it != itend; ++it) {
4821 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4822 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4823 // 1) void pointer
4824 // 2) null pointer constant
4825 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004826 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004827 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004828 InitField = *it;
4829 break;
4830 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004831
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004832 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004833 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004834 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004835 InitField = *it;
4836 break;
4837 }
4838 }
4839
4840 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4841 == Compatible) {
4842 InitField = *it;
4843 break;
4844 }
4845 }
4846
4847 if (!InitField)
4848 return Incompatible;
4849
4850 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
4851 return Compatible;
4852}
4853
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004854Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004855Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004856 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4857 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
4858 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
4859 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
4860 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00004861 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00004862 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004863 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00004864 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004865 }
4866
4867 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
4868 // structures.
4869 }
4870
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004871 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
4872 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004873 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
4874 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004875 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004876 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004877 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004878 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00004879 return Compatible;
4880 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004881
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004882 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004883 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00004884 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004885 // expressions that surpress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004886 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004887 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00004888 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004889 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004890
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004891 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
4892 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004893
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004894 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
4895 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004896 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
4897 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
4898 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
4899 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004900 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004901 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonReferenceType(),
4902 CastExpr::CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00004903 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00004904}
4905
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004906QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004907 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00004908 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004909 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00004910 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004911}
4912
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004913QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004914 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004915 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004916 QualType lhsType =
4917 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
4918 QualType rhsType =
4919 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004920
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004921 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00004922 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004923 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004924
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004925 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
4926 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004927 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
4928 // FIXME: Should we warn here?
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004929 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4930 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004931 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004932 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004933 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4934 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4935 return lhsType;
4936 }
4937
4938 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
4939 return rhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004940 }
4941 }
4942 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004943
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004944 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
4945 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
4946 bool swapped = false;
4947 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4948 swapped = true;
4949 std::swap(rex, lex);
4950 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
4951 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004952
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004953 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004954 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004955 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
4956 if (EltTy->isIntegralType() && rhsType->isIntegralType()) {
4957 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004958 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004959 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4960 return lhsType;
4961 }
4962 }
4963 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
4964 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
4965 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004966 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CastExpr::CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004967 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
4968 return lhsType;
4969 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00004970 }
4971 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004972
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00004973 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004974 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004975 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00004976 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004977 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00004978}
4979
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004980QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
4981 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00004982 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00004983 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004984
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00004985 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004986
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004987 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
4988 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
4989 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004990
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004991 // Check for division by zero.
4992 if (isDiv &&
4993 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004994 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00004995 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004996
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00004997 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004998}
4999
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005000QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005001 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005002 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5003 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5004 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5005 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5006 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005007
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005008 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005009
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005010 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5011 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005012
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005013 // Check for remainder by zero.
5014 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005015 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5016 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005017
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005018 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005019}
5020
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005021QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005022 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005023 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5024 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5025 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5026 return compType;
5027 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005028
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005029 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005030
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005031 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005032 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5033 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5034 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005035 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005036 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005037
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005038 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5039 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005040 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005041 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5042
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005043 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005044
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005045 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005046 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005047
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005048 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5049 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005050 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5051 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005052 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005053 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005054 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005055
5056 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5057 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5058 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005059 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005060 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5061 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5062 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5063 return QualType();
5064 }
5065
5066 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5067 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5068 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005069 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005070 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005071 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005072 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005073 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5074 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005075 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5076 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005077 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005078 return QualType();
5079 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005080 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005081 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005082 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5083 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5084 return QualType();
5085 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005086
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005087 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005088 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5089 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5090 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5091 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5092 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005093 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005094 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5095 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005096 return PExp->getType();
5097 }
5098 }
5099
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005100 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005101}
5102
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005103// C99 6.5.6
5104QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005105 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5106 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5107 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5108 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5109 return compType;
5110 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005111
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005112 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005113
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005114 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005115
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005116 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005117 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5118 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005119 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005120 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005121 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005122
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005123 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005124 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005125 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005126
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005127 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005128
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005129 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5130 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5131 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5132 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5133 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5134 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5135 return QualType();
5136 }
5137
5138 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5139 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5140 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5141 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5142 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005143 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005144 return QualType();
5145 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005146
5147 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5148 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5149 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005150 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005151 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005152 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005153 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005154 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005155
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005156 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005157 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005158 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5159 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5160 return QualType();
5161 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005162
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005163 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005164 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5165 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5166 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5167 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5168 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5169 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005170 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005171 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5172
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005173 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005174 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005175 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005176
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005177 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005178 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005179 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005180
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005181 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5182 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5183 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5184 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5185 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5186 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5187 return QualType();
5188 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005189
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005190 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5191 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5192 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5193 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005194 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005195 return QualType();
5196 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005197
5198 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5199 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5200 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5201 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5202 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005203 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5204 << rex->getSourceRange()
5205 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005206 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005207
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005208 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5209 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5210 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5211 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5212 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5213 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5214 return QualType();
5215 }
5216 } else {
5217 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5218 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5219 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5220 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5221 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5222 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5223 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5224 return QualType();
5225 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005226 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005227
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005228 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5229 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5230 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5231 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5232 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005233 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005234 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005235
5236 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005237 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5238 }
5239 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005240
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005241 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005242}
5243
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005244// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005245QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005246 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005247 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
5248 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005249 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005250
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005251 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5252 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5253 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5254
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005255 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5256 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005257 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5258 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5259 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5260 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5261 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005262 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005263 if (!isCompAssign)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005264 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CastExpr::CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005265
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005266 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005267
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005268 // Sanity-check shift operands
5269 llvm::APSInt Right;
5270 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005271 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5272 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005273 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005274 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5275 else {
5276 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5277 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5278 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5279 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5280 }
5281 }
5282
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005283 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005284 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005285}
5286
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005287// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005288QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005289 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
5290 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)OpaqueOpc;
5291
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005292 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005293 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005294 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005295
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005296 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
Steve Naroff30bf7712007-08-10 18:26:40 +00005297 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5298 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5299 else {
5300 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5301 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5302 }
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005303 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5304 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005305
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005306 if (!lType->isFloatingType()
5307 && !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational)) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005308 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5309 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5310 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005311 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparisons of enum constants. These can arise
Ted Kremenek9ecede72009-03-20 19:57:37 +00005312 // from macro expansions, and are usually quite deliberate.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005313 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5314 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
5315 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped))
5316 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped))
Ted Kremenekb82dcd82009-03-20 18:35:45 +00005317 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
5318 !isa<EnumConstantDecl>(DRL->getDecl()))
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005319 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005320
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005321 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5322 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5323 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5324 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005325
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005326 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5327 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005328 Expr *literalString = 0;
5329 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005330 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005331 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005332 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005333 literalString = lex;
5334 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005335 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5336 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005337 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005338 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005339 literalString = rex;
5340 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5341 }
5342
5343 if (literalString) {
5344 std::string resultComparison;
5345 switch (Opc) {
5346 case BinaryOperator::LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5347 case BinaryOperator::GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5348 case BinaryOperator::LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5349 case BinaryOperator::GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5350 case BinaryOperator::EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5351 case BinaryOperator::NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
5352 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5353 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005354
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005355 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5356 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5357 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005358 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005359 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005360 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005361
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005362 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005363 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005364
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005365 if (isRelational) {
5366 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005367 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005368 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005369 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005370 if (lType->isFloatingType() && rType->isFloatingType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005371 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005372
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005373 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005374 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005375 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005376
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005377 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005378 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005379 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005380 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005381
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005382 // All of the following pointer related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5383 // when handling null pointer constants. One day, we can consider making them
5384 // errors (when -pedantic-errors is enabled).
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005385 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005386 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005387 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005388 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005389 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005390
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005391 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005392 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5393 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005394 if (!isRelational &&
5395 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5396 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5397 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
5398 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5399 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5400 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5401 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5402 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5403 return ResultTy;
5404 }
5405 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005406 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5407 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5408 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5409 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5410 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5411 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005412 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005413 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005414 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005415 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005416 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005417 if (T.isNull()) {
5418 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5419 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5420 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005421 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005422 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005423 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005424 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005425 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005426 }
5427
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005428 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5429 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005430 return ResultTy;
5431 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005432 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5433 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5434 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5435 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5436 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5437 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5438 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5439 }
5440 } else if (!isRelational &&
5441 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5442 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5443 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5444 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5445 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5446 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5447 }
5448 } else {
5449 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005450 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005451 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005452 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005453 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005454 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005455 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005456 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005457
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005458 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005459 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005460 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005461 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005462 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5463 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005464 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005465 return ResultTy;
5466 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005467 if (LHSIsNull &&
5468 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5469 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Anders Carlsson26ba8502009-08-24 18:03:14 +00005470 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005471 return ResultTy;
5472 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005473
5474 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005475 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005476 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5477 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005478 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5479 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5480 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5481 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5482 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5483 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5484 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5485 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005486 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005487 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005488 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005489 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005490 if (T.isNull()) {
5491 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005492 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005493 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005494 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005495 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005496 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005497 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005498 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005499 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005500
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005501 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
5502 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005503 return ResultTy;
5504 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005505
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005506 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005507 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5508 return ResultTy;
5509 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005510
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005511 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005512 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005513 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5514 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005515
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005516 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005517 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005518 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005519 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005520 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005521 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005522 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005523 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005524 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005525 if (!isRelational
5526 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5527 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005528 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005529 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005530 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005531 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005532 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5533 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5534 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005535 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005536 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005537 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005538 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005539
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005540 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005541 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005542 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5543 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005544 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005545 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005546 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005547 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005548
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005549 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5550 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005551 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005552 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005553 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005554 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005555 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005556 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005557 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005558 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005559 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5560 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005561 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005562 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005563 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005564 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005565 if (lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005566 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5567 if (RHSIsNull) {
5568 if (isRelational)
5569 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5570 } else if (isRelational)
5571 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5572 else
5573 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005574
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005575 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005576 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005577 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005578 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005579 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005580 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005581 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005582 if (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005583 unsigned DiagID = 0;
5584 if (LHSIsNull) {
5585 if (isRelational)
5586 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
5587 } else if (isRelational)
5588 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5589 else
5590 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005591
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005592 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005593 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005594 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005595 }
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005596 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005597 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005598 }
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005599 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005600 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5601 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005602 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005603 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005604 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005605 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5606 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00005607 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CastExpr::CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005608 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005609 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005610 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005611}
5612
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005613/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005614/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005615/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5616/// types.
5617QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005618 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005619 bool isRelational) {
5620 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5621 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005622 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005623 if (vType.isNull())
5624 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005625
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005626 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5627 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005628
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005629 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5630 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5631 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
5632 if (!lType->isFloatingType()) {
5633 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5634 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5635 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005636 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_selfcomparison));
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005637 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005638
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005639 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
5640 if (!isRelational && lType->isFloatingType()) {
5641 assert (rType->isFloatingType());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005642 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005643 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005644
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005645 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5646 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5647 // elements for floating point vectors.
5648 if (lType->isIntegerType())
5649 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005650
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005651 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005652 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005653 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005654 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005655 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005656 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5657
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005658 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005659 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005660 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5661}
5662
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005663inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005664 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Steve Naroff3e5e5562007-07-16 22:23:01 +00005665 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005666 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005667
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005668 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005669
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005670 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005671 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005672 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005673}
5674
5675inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005676 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc) {
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005677 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5678 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5679 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005680
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005681 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5682 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005683
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005684 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005685 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005686
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005687 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5688 // non-overloadable operands.
5689
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005690 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5691 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005692 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5693 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5694 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005695 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005696
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005697 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5698 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5699 // The result is a bool.
5700 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005701}
5702
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005703/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5704/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5705/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5706///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005707static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005708 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5709 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5710 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5711 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005712 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005713 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5714 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5715 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5716 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005717 }
5718 }
5719 return false;
5720}
5721
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005722/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5723/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5724static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005725 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005726 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005727 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005728 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5729 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005730 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5731 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005732
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005733 unsigned Diag = 0;
5734 bool NeedType = false;
5735 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005736 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005737 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005738 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5739 NeedType = true;
5740 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005741 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005742 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5743 NeedType = true;
5744 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00005745 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005746 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
5747 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005748 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
5749 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005750 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00005751 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
5752 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005753 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5754 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005755 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
5756 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00005757 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005758 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00005759 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005760 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005761 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
5762 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00005763 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005764 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5765 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00005766 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
5767 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
5768 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00005769 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
5770 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
5771 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00005772 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
5773 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
5774 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005775 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00005776
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005777 SourceRange Assign;
5778 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
5779 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005780 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005781 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005782 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005783 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005784 return true;
5785}
5786
5787
5788
5789// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005790QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
5791 SourceLocation Loc,
5792 QualType CompoundType) {
5793 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
5794 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005795 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005796
5797 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
5798 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005799 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005800 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005801 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005802 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00005803 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
5804 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
5805 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
5806 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
5807 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
5808 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
5809 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
5810 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
5811 }
5812 }
5813
5814 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005815 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
5816 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
5817 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005818 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005819 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00005820 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00005821 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005822
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005823 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
5824 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
5825 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005826 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005827 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
5828 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
5829 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
5830 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ||
5831 UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005832 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005833 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005834 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
5835 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
5836 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00005837 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
5838 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00005839 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
5840 << (UO->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Plus ? "+" : "-")
5841 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00005842 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005843 }
5844 } else {
5845 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00005846 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00005847 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005848
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005849 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005850 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005851 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005852
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005853 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
5854 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005855 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005856 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
5857 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00005858 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005859 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005860 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005861}
5862
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005863// C99 6.5.17
5864QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00005865 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005866 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
5867 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
5868 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00005869
5870 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
5871 // incomplete in C++).
5872
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005873 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005874}
5875
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005876/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
5877/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005878QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005879 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00005880 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
5881 return Context.DependentTy;
5882
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005883 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
5884 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005885
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00005886 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
5887 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
5888 if (!isInc) {
5889 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5890 return QualType();
5891 }
5892 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
5893 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
5894 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005895 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005896 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
5897 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005898
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005899 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005900 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005901 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5902 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5903 << Op->getSourceRange();
5904 return QualType();
5905 }
5906
5907 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005908 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005909 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005910 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5911 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5912 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
5913 return QualType();
5914 }
5915
5916 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005917 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005918 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005919 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005920 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005921 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005922 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005923 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005924 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00005925 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5926 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
5927 return QualType();
5928 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00005929 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005930 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
5931 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005932 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005933 } else {
5934 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00005935 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005936 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005937 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005938 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00005939 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00005940 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005941 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00005942 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
5943 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
5944 // operand.
5945 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
5946 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005947}
5948
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005949/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005950/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005951/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
5952/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
5953/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
5954/// - &(x) => x
5955/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
5956/// - &s.xx => s
5957/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
5958/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
5959/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
5960/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005961static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005962 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005963 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005964 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005965 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005966 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
5967 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
5968 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005969 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005970 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005971 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005972 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005973 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00005974 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
5975 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005976 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
5977 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
5978 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
5979 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
5980 }
5981 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00005982 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005983 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
5984 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005985
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005986 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00005987 case UnaryOperator::Real:
5988 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
5989 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
5990 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
5991 default:
5992 return 0;
5993 }
5994 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005995 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00005996 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00005997 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00005998 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
5999 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006000 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006001 default:
6002 return 0;
6003 }
6004}
6005
6006/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006007/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006008/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006009/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006010/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006011/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006012/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006013QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006014 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6015 op = op->IgnoreParens();
6016
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006017 if (op->isTypeDependent())
6018 return Context.DependentTy;
6019
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006020 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6021 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6022 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
6023 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::Deref)
6024 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6025 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6026 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6027 }
6028 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6029 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6030 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006031 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006032 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006033
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006034 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(op);
6035 if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction && ME &&
6036 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) {
6037 ValueDecl *dcl = cast<MemberExpr>(op)->getMemberDecl();
6038 // &f where f is a member of the current object, or &o.f, or &p->f
6039 // All these are not allowed, and we need to catch them before the dcl
6040 // branch of the if, below.
6041 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6042 << dcl;
6043 // FIXME: Improve this diagnostic and provide a fixit.
6044
6045 // Now recover by acting as if the function had been accessed qualified.
6046 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6047 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(dcl->getDeclContext()))
6048 .getTypePtr());
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006049 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
6050 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6051 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6052 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6053 if (isSFINAEContext())
6054 return QualType();
Sebastian Redle27d87f2010-01-11 15:56:56 +00006055 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006056 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006057 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006058 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006059 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006060 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6061 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006062 return QualType();
6063 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006064 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006065 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6066 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6067 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006068 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006069 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006070 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006071 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006072 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006073 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006074 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6075 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6076 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6077 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6078 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006079 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6080 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006081 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6082 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006083 } else if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(op)) {
6084 return Context.OverloadTy;
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006085 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006086 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006087 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6088 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
6089 if (vd->getStorageClass() == VarDecl::Register) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006090 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6091 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006092 return QualType();
6093 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006094 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006095 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006096 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006097 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006098 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6099 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006100 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006101 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006102 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6103 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006104 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006105 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6106 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6107 return QualType();
6108 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006109
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006110 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6111 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006112 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006113 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006114 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
Nuno Lopes6fea8d22008-12-16 22:58:26 +00006115 // Okay: we can take the address of a function.
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006116 // As above.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006117 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier() &&
6118 MD->isInstance())
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006119 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6120 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6121 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006122 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006123 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006124
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006125 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6126 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6127 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6128 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6129 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6130 }
6131
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006132 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
6133 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6134}
6135
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006136QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006137 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6138 return Context.DependentTy;
6139
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006140 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
6141 QualType Ty = Op->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006142
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006143 // Note that per both C89 and C99, this is always legal, even if ptype is an
6144 // incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about dereferencing
6145 // a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a warning is
6146 // unlikely to catch any mistakes.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006147 if (const PointerType *PT = Ty->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006148 return PT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006149
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006150 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Fariborz Jahanian16b10372009-09-03 00:43:07 +00006151 return OPT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006152
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006153 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006154 << Ty << Op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006155 return QualType();
6156}
6157
6158static inline BinaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
6159 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6160 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6161 switch (Kind) {
6162 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006163 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemD; break;
6164 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BinaryOperator::PtrMemI; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006165 case tok::star: Opc = BinaryOperator::Mul; break;
6166 case tok::slash: Opc = BinaryOperator::Div; break;
6167 case tok::percent: Opc = BinaryOperator::Rem; break;
6168 case tok::plus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Add; break;
6169 case tok::minus: Opc = BinaryOperator::Sub; break;
6170 case tok::lessless: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shl; break;
6171 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BinaryOperator::Shr; break;
6172 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::LE; break;
6173 case tok::less: Opc = BinaryOperator::LT; break;
6174 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::GE; break;
6175 case tok::greater: Opc = BinaryOperator::GT; break;
6176 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::NE; break;
6177 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::EQ; break;
6178 case tok::amp: Opc = BinaryOperator::And; break;
6179 case tok::caret: Opc = BinaryOperator::Xor; break;
6180 case tok::pipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::Or; break;
6181 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BinaryOperator::LAnd; break;
6182 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BinaryOperator::LOr; break;
6183 case tok::equal: Opc = BinaryOperator::Assign; break;
6184 case tok::starequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::MulAssign; break;
6185 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::DivAssign; break;
6186 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::RemAssign; break;
6187 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AddAssign; break;
6188 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::SubAssign; break;
6189 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShlAssign; break;
6190 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::ShrAssign; break;
6191 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::AndAssign; break;
6192 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::XorAssign; break;
6193 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BinaryOperator::OrAssign; break;
6194 case tok::comma: Opc = BinaryOperator::Comma; break;
6195 }
6196 return Opc;
6197}
6198
6199static inline UnaryOperator::Opcode ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
6200 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
6201 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc;
6202 switch (Kind) {
6203 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
6204 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreInc; break;
6205 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UnaryOperator::PreDec; break;
6206 case tok::amp: Opc = UnaryOperator::AddrOf; break;
6207 case tok::star: Opc = UnaryOperator::Deref; break;
6208 case tok::plus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Plus; break;
6209 case tok::minus: Opc = UnaryOperator::Minus; break;
6210 case tok::tilde: Opc = UnaryOperator::Not; break;
6211 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UnaryOperator::LNot; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006212 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UnaryOperator::Real; break;
6213 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UnaryOperator::Imag; break;
6214 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UnaryOperator::Extension; break;
6215 }
6216 return Opc;
6217}
6218
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006219/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6220/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6221/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006222Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6223 unsigned Op,
6224 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006225 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006226 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = (BinaryOperator::Opcode)Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006227 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6228 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6229 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006230
6231 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006232 case BinaryOperator::Assign:
6233 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6234 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006235 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemD:
6236 case BinaryOperator::PtrMemI:
6237 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
6238 Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemI);
6239 break;
6240 case BinaryOperator::Mul:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006241 case BinaryOperator::Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006242 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
6243 Opc == BinaryOperator::Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006244 break;
6245 case BinaryOperator::Rem:
6246 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6247 break;
6248 case BinaryOperator::Add:
6249 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6250 break;
6251 case BinaryOperator::Sub:
6252 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6253 break;
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006254 case BinaryOperator::Shl:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006255 case BinaryOperator::Shr:
6256 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6257 break;
6258 case BinaryOperator::LE:
6259 case BinaryOperator::LT:
6260 case BinaryOperator::GE:
6261 case BinaryOperator::GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006262 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006263 break;
6264 case BinaryOperator::EQ:
6265 case BinaryOperator::NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006266 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006267 break;
6268 case BinaryOperator::And:
6269 case BinaryOperator::Xor:
6270 case BinaryOperator::Or:
6271 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6272 break;
6273 case BinaryOperator::LAnd:
6274 case BinaryOperator::LOr:
6275 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6276 break;
6277 case BinaryOperator::MulAssign:
6278 case BinaryOperator::DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006279 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
6280 Opc == BinaryOperator::DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006281 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6282 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6283 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006284 break;
6285 case BinaryOperator::RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006286 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6287 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6288 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6289 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006290 break;
6291 case BinaryOperator::AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006292 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6293 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6294 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006295 break;
6296 case BinaryOperator::SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006297 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6298 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6299 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006300 break;
6301 case BinaryOperator::ShlAssign:
6302 case BinaryOperator::ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006303 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6304 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6305 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6306 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006307 break;
6308 case BinaryOperator::AndAssign:
6309 case BinaryOperator::XorAssign:
6310 case BinaryOperator::OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006311 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6312 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6313 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6314 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006315 break;
6316 case BinaryOperator::Comma:
6317 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6318 break;
6319 }
6320 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006321 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006322 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006323 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6324 else
6325 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006326 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6327 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006328}
6329
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006330/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6331/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006332static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6333 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006334 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6335 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6336 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006337 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006338 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6339
6340 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6341 return;
6342
6343 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6344 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6345 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006346 return;
6347 }
6348
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006349 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6350 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006351 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006352
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006353 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006354 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006355
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006356 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6357 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6358 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6359 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006360 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006361 return;
6362 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006363
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006364 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006365 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6366 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006367}
6368
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006369/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6370/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6371/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6372/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006373static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6374 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006375 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6376 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6377 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6378 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006379 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006380 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006381 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6382
6383 // Subs are not binary operators.
6384 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6385 return;
6386
6387 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6388 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006389 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6390 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006391 return;
6392
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006393 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006394 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006395 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006396 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6397 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006398 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006399 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006400 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6401 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6402 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6403 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006404 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006405 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006406 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006407 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6408 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006409 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006410 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006411 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6412 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6413 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6414 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006415}
6416
6417/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6418/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6419/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
6420static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6421 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006422 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006423 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6424}
6425
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006426// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006427Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
6428 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6429 ExprArg LHS, ExprArg RHS) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006430 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00006431 Expr *lhs = LHS.takeAs<Expr>(), *rhs = RHS.takeAs<Expr>();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006432
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006433 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6434 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006435
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006436 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6437 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6438
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006439 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6440}
6441
6442Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6443 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6444 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006445 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006446 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006447 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6448 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6449 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6450 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6451 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006452 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006453 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006454 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6455 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6456 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006457
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006458 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6459 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006460 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006461 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006462
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006463 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006464 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006465}
6466
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006467Action::OwningExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006468 unsigned OpcIn,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006469 ExprArg InputArg) {
6470 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006471
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006472 // FIXME: Input is modified below, but InputArg is not updated appropriately.
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006473 Expr *Input = (Expr *)InputArg.get();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006474 QualType resultType;
6475 switch (Opc) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006476 case UnaryOperator::OffsetOf:
6477 assert(false && "Invalid unary operator");
6478 break;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006479
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006480 case UnaryOperator::PreInc:
6481 case UnaryOperator::PreDec:
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006482 case UnaryOperator::PostInc:
6483 case UnaryOperator::PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006484 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
Eli Friedmande99a452009-07-22 22:25:00 +00006485 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006486 Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc,
6487 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreInc ||
6488 Opc == UnaryOperator::PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006489 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006490 case UnaryOperator::AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006491 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6492 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006493 case UnaryOperator::Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006494 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006495 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6496 break;
6497 case UnaryOperator::Plus:
6498 case UnaryOperator::Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006499 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6500 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006501 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6502 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006503 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6504 break;
6505 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6506 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6507 break;
6508 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
6509 Opc == UnaryOperator::Plus &&
6510 resultType->isPointerType())
6511 break;
6512
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006513 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6514 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006515 case UnaryOperator::Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006516 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6517 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006518 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6519 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006520 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6521 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6522 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006523 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006524 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006525 else if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006526 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6527 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006528 break;
6529 case UnaryOperator::LNot: // logical negation
6530 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006531 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006532 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006533 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6534 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006535 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006536 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6537 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006538 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006539 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6540 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006541 break;
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006542 case UnaryOperator::Real:
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006543 case UnaryOperator::Imag:
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00006544 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UnaryOperator::Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006545 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006546 case UnaryOperator::Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006547 resultType = Input->getType();
6548 break;
6549 }
6550 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006551 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006552
6553 InputArg.release();
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006554 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006555}
6556
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006557Action::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6558 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc,
6559 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006560 Expr *Input = (Expr*)input.get();
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006561 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
6562 Opc != UnaryOperator::Extension) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006563 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6564 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6565 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6566 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006567 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006568 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006569 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6570 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6571 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006572
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006573 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, move(input));
6574 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006575
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006576 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, move(input));
6577}
6578
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006579// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
6580Action::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6581 tok::TokenKind Op, ExprArg input) {
6582 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), move(input));
6583}
6584
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006585/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006586Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
6587 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6588 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006589 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
Chris Lattnerea29a3a2009-04-18 20:01:55 +00006590 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getLabelMap()[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006591
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006592 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6593 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006594 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006595 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006596
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006597 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006598 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6599 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006600}
6601
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006602Sema::OwningExprResult
6603Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, StmtArg substmt,
6604 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
6605 Stmt *SubStmt = static_cast<Stmt*>(substmt.get());
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006606 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6607 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6608
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006609 bool isFileScope
6610 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006611 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006612 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006613
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006614 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6615 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6616 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006617
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006618 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6619 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6620 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006621
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006622 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6623 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6624 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6625 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6626 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006627
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006628 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006629 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006630 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006631
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006632 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6633 // expressions are not lvalues.
6634
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006635 substmt.release();
6636 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006637}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006638
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006639Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6640 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006641 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6642 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006643 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6644 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006645 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006646 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006647
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006648 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6649 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6650 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006651 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006652 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6653 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6654
6655 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6656 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6657 if (!Dependent
6658 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6659 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6660 << TypeRange))
6661 return ExprError();
6662
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006663 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6664 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006665 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6666 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006667 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006668 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6669 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006670
6671 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6672 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6673 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6674 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6675 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6676 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6677 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6678 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6679 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6680 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6681 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
6682 if(!AT)
6683 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
6684 << CurrentType);
6685 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
6686 } else
6687 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6688
6689 // The expression must be an integral expression.
6690 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
6691 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
6692 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
6693 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
6694 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
6695 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
6696 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6697
6698 // Record this array index.
6699 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
6700 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
6701 continue;
6702 }
6703
6704 // Offset of a field.
6705 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
6706 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
6707 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
6708 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
6709 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
6710 continue;
6711 }
6712
6713 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
6714 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
6715 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6716 return ExprError();
6717
6718 // Look for the designated field.
6719 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
6720 if (!RC)
6721 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6722 << CurrentType);
6723 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
6724
6725 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
6726 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
6727 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
6728 // (clause 9).
6729 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
6730 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6731 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6732 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
6733 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6734 << CurrentType))
6735 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
6736 }
6737
6738 // Look for the field.
6739 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6740 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
6741 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
6742 if (!MemberDecl)
6743 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
6744 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
6745 OC.LocEnd));
6746
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006747 // C99 7.17p3:
6748 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6749 //
6750 // We diagnose this as an error.
6751 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6752 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6753 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6754 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
6755 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6756 return ExprError();
6757 }
6758
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00006759 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
6760 // the base class indirections.
6761 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
6762 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
6763 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType,
6764 Context.getTypeDeclType(MemberDecl->getParent()),
6765 Paths)) {
6766 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
6767 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
6768 B != BEnd; ++B)
6769 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
6770 }
6771
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006772 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006773 isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006774 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
6775 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
6776 unsigned n = Path.size();
6777 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
6778 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
6779 } else {
6780 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
6781 }
6782 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
6783 }
6784
6785 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
6786 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
6787 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
6788}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006789
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006790Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
6791 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6792 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
6793 TypeTy *argty,
6794 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6795 unsigned NumComponents,
6796 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6797
6798 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
6799 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
6800 if (ArgTy.isNull())
6801 return ExprError();
6802
6803 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6804 if (!ArgTInfo)
6805 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
6806
6807 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
6808 RPLoc);
6809 }
6810
6811 // FIXME: The code below is marked for death, once we have proper CodeGen
6812 // support for non-constant OffsetOf expressions.
6813
6814 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
6815
6816 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6817 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6818 // a struct/union/class.
6819 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
6820 return ExprError(Diag(TypeLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) << ArgTy);
6821
6822 // FIXME: Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6823 // with an incomplete type would be illegal.
6824
6825 // Otherwise, create a null pointer as the base, and iteratively process
6826 // the offsetof designators.
6827 QualType ArgTyPtr = Context.getPointerType(ArgTy);
6828 Expr* Res = new (Context) ImplicitValueInitExpr(ArgTyPtr);
6829 Res = new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::Deref,
6830 ArgTy, SourceLocation());
6831
6832 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6833 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
6834 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6835 // a system header!
6836 if (NumComponents != 1)
6837 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6838 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
6839
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006840 if (!Dependent) {
Eli Friedmanc0d600c2009-05-03 21:22:18 +00006841 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006842
John McCalld00f2002009-11-04 03:03:43 +00006843 if (RequireCompleteType(TypeLoc, Res->getType(),
6844 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
6845 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006846
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006847 // FIXME: Dependent case loses a lot of information here. And probably
6848 // leaks like a sieve.
6849 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6850 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6851 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6852 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6853 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(Res->getType());
6854 if (!AT) {
6855 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006856 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006857 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006858 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006859
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006860 // FIXME: C++: Verify that operator[] isn't overloaded.
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006861
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006862 // Promote the array so it looks more like a normal array subscript
6863 // expression.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006864 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Res);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006865
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006866 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
6867 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006868 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006869 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006870 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00006871 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006872 << Idx->getSourceRange());
6873
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006874 Res = new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(Res, Idx, AT->getElementType(),
6875 OC.LocEnd);
6876 continue;
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006877 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006878
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006879 const RecordType *RC = Res->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006880 if (!RC) {
6881 Res->Destroy(Context);
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006882 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006883 << Res->getType());
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006884 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006885
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006886 // Get the decl corresponding to this.
6887 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006888 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006889 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
6890 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
6891 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006892 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
6893 << Res->getType()))
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00006894 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
Anders Carlsson6d7f1492009-05-01 23:20:30 +00006895 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006896
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006897 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
6898 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006899
John McCall1bcee0a2009-12-02 08:25:40 +00006900 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006901 // FIXME: Leaks Res
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006902 if (!MemberDecl)
Douglas Gregor3f093272009-10-13 21:16:44 +00006903 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006904 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, OC.LocEnd));
6905
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00006906 // C99 7.17p3:
6907 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
6908 //
6909 // We diagnose this as an error.
6910 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
6911 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
6912 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
6913 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6914 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
6915 return ExprError();
6916 }
6917
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006918 // FIXME: C++: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a static field.
6919 // FIXME: Verify that MemberDecl isn't a bitfield.
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006920 if (cast<RecordDecl>(MemberDecl->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
Anders Carlssonf1b1d592009-05-01 19:30:39 +00006921 Res = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006922 OC.LocEnd, MemberDecl, Res, OC.LocEnd).takeAs<Expr>();
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006923 } else {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006924 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Res, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6925 *R.begin(), MemberDecl);
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006926 // MemberDecl->getType() doesn't get the right qualifiers, but it
6927 // doesn't matter here.
6928 Res = new (Context) MemberExpr(Res, false, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006929 MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType());
Eli Friedmane9356962009-04-26 20:50:44 +00006930 }
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006931 }
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006932 }
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006933
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006934 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Res, UnaryOperator::OffsetOf,
6935 Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc));
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006936}
6937
6938
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006939Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6940 TypeTy *arg1,TypeTy *arg2,
6941 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00006942 // FIXME: Preserve type source info.
6943 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1);
6944 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006945
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006946 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006947
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00006948 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6949 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
6950 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
6951 return ExprError();
6952 }
6953
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006954 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
6955 argT1, argT2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006956}
6957
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006958Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
6959 ExprArg cond,
6960 ExprArg expr1, ExprArg expr2,
6961 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
6962 Expr *CondExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(cond.get());
6963 Expr *LHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr1.get());
6964 Expr *RHSExpr = static_cast<Expr*>(expr2.get());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006965
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006966 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
6967
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006968 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006969 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00006970 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006971 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006972 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006973 } else {
6974 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
6975 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
6976 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
6977 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006978 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
6979 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
6980 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006981
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006982 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
6983 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006984 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
6985 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006986 }
6987
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006988 cond.release(); expr1.release(); expr2.release();
6989 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006990 resType, RPLoc,
6991 resType->isDependentType(),
6992 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00006993}
6994
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00006995//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6996// Clang Extensions.
6997//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6998
6999/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007000void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007001 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7002 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7003 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
7004 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007005}
7006
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007007void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007008 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007009 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007010
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007011 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007012 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007013 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007014
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007015 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007016 QualType RetTy;
7017 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007018 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007019 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007020 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007021 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7022 } else {
7023 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007024 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007025 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007026
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007027 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007028
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007029 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7030 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7031 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007032 return;
7033 }
7034
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007035 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7036 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7037 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7038 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7039 return;
7040 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007041
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007042 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007043 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7044 // ^ * { ... }
7045 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007046 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7047 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007048
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007049 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007050 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007051 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7052 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7053 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7054 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007055 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7056 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7057 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7058 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7059 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007060 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007061 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007062
7063 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7064 // ^ fntype { ... }
7065 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7066 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7067 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7068 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7069 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7070 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7071 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007072 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007073 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007074 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007075
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007076 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7077 if (!Params.empty())
7078 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007079
7080 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007081 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007082
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007083 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007084 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7085 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7086 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7087 }
7088
7089 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7090 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007091 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007092 return;
7093
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007094 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7095 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7096
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007097 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007098 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7099 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7100
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007101 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007102 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7103 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7104 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7105
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007106 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007107 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007108 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007109}
7110
7111/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7112/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7113void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007114 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007115 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007116 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007117 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007118}
7119
7120/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7121/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007122Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7123 StmtArg body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007124 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7125 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7126 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007127
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007128 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007129
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007130 PopDeclContext();
7131
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007132 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007133 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7134 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007135
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007136 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007137 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007138
7139 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7140 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7141 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7142
7143 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7144 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7145
7146 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7147 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7148 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7149 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7150
7151 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7152 // preserve its sugar structure.
7153 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7154 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7155 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7156
7157 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7158 } else {
7159 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7160 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7161 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7162 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7163 FPT->isVariadic(),
7164 /*quals*/ 0,
7165 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7166 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7167 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7168 FPT->exception_begin(),
7169 Ext);
7170 }
7171
7172 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7173 } else {
7174 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7175 false, false, 0, 0,
7176 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7177 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007178
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007179 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007180 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7181 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007182 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007183
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007184 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007185 if (FunctionNeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007186 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(static_cast<CompoundStmt*>(body.get()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007187
Anders Carlssone9146f22009-05-01 19:49:17 +00007188 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(body.takeAs<CompoundStmt>());
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007189
7190 bool Good = true;
7191 // Check goto/label use.
7192 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7193 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7194 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7195
7196 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7197 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
7198 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0)
7199 continue;
7200
7201 // Emit error.
7202 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7203 Good = false;
7204 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007205 if (!Good) {
7206 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007207 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007208 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007209
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007210 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007211 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7212 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
7213 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007214
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007215 Expr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7216 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007217 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007218 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007219}
7220
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007221Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7222 ExprArg expr, TypeTy *type,
7223 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise8661902009-08-19 01:28:28 +00007224 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type);
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007225 Expr *E = static_cast<Expr*>(expr.get());
7226 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007227
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007228 InitBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007229
7230 // Get the va_list type
7231 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007232 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7233 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7234 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7235 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007236 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007237 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7238 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7239 } else {
7240 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7241 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007242 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007243 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007244 return ExprError();
7245 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007246
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007247 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7248 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007249 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7250 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007251 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007252 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007253
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007254 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007255 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007256
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007257 expr.release();
7258 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, T.getNonReferenceType(),
7259 RPLoc));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007260}
7261
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007262Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007263 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7264 // pointers on the target.
7265 QualType Ty;
7266 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7267 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7268 else
7269 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7270
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007271 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007272}
7273
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007274static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007275 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007276 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7277 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007278
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007279 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7280 if (!PT)
7281 return;
7282
7283 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7284 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7285 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7286 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7287 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7288 return;
7289 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007290
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007291 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7292 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7293 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7294 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007295
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007296 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007297}
7298
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007299bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7300 SourceLocation Loc,
7301 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007302 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7303 bool *Complained) {
7304 if (Complained)
7305 *Complained = false;
7306
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007307 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7308 bool isInvalid = false;
7309 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007310 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007311
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007312 switch (ConvTy) {
7313 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7314 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007315 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007316 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7317 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007318 case IntToPointer:
7319 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7320 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007321 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007322 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007323 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7324 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007325 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7326 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7327 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007328 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7329 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7330 break;
7331 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007332 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7333 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7334 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7335 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7336 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7337 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7338 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7339 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7340 // C++ semantics.
7341 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7342 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7343 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007344 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7345 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007346 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007347 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007348 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007349 case IntToBlockPointer:
7350 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7351 break;
7352 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007353 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007354 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007355 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007356 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007357 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7358 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7359 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007360 case IncompatibleVectors:
7361 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7362 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007363 case Incompatible:
7364 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7365 isInvalid = true;
7366 break;
7367 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007368
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007369 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7370 switch (Action) {
7371 case AA_Assigning:
7372 case AA_Initializing:
7373 // The destination type comes first.
7374 FirstType = DstType;
7375 SecondType = SrcType;
7376 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007377
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007378 case AA_Returning:
7379 case AA_Passing:
7380 case AA_Converting:
7381 case AA_Sending:
7382 case AA_Casting:
7383 // The source type comes first.
7384 FirstType = SrcType;
7385 SecondType = DstType;
7386 break;
7387 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007388
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007389 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007390 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007391 if (Complained)
7392 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007393 return isInvalid;
7394}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007395
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007396bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007397 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7398 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7399 if (Result)
7400 *Result = ICEResult;
7401 return false;
7402 }
7403
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007404 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7405
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007406 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007407 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7408 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7409
7410 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7411 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7412 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7413 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7414 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7415 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7416 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007417
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007418 return true;
7419 }
7420
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007421 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7422 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007423
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007424 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7425 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7426 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007427
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007428 if (Result)
7429 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7430 return false;
7431}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007432
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007433void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007434Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007435 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7436 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007437}
7438
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007439void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007440Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7441 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7442 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7443 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007444
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007445 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7446 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7447 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7448 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7449 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007450 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007451 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7452 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7453 I != IEnd; ++I)
7454 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7455 }
7456
7457 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7458 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7459 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7460 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7461 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7462 I != IEnd; ++I)
7463 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7464 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007465 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007466
7467 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7468 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7469 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7470 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007471 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007472 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7473 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7474 ExprTemporaries.end());
7475
7476 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7477 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007478}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007479
7480/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7481///
7482/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7483/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7484/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7485/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7486///
7487/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7488///
7489/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7490void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7491 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007492
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007493 if (D->isUsed())
7494 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007495
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007496 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7497 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7498 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7499 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007500 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007501 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007502 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007503 return;
7504 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007505
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007506 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7507 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007508
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007509 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7510 // an instantiation.
7511 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7512 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007513
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007514 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007515 case Unevaluated:
7516 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7517 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007518
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007519 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7520 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7521 // "used"; handle this below.
7522 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007523
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007524 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7525 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7526 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7527 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007528 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007529 return;
7530 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007531
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007532 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007533 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007534 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007535 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
7536 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7537 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007538 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007539 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007540 if (!Constructor->isUsed())
7541 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7542 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007543
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007544 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007545 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
7546 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed())
7547 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007548 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7549 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007550 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7551 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7552 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
7553 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed())
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007554 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007555 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7556 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007557 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007558 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007559 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007560 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007561 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007562 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7563 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7564 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7565 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7566 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007567 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007568 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007569 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007570 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007571 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7572 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7573 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007574 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007575 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007576 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7577 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007578
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007579 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7580 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7581 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7582 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7583 Loc));
7584 else
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007585 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007586 Loc));
7587 }
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007588 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007589
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007590 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007591 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007592
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007593 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007594 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007595
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007596 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007597 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007598 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007599 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7600 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7601 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7602 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7603 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7604 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
7605 PendingImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
7606 }
7607 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007608
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007609 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007610
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007611 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007612 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007613 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007614}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007615
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007616namespace {
7617 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
7618 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
7619 // of when we're entering
7620 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7621 Sema &S;
7622 SourceLocation Loc;
7623
7624 public:
7625 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
7626
7627 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
7628
7629 bool VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7630 bool VisitRecordType(RecordType *T);
7631 };
7632}
7633
7634bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
7635 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7636 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7637 }
7638
7639 return Inherited::VisitTemplateArgument(Arg);
7640}
7641
7642bool MarkReferencedDecls::VisitRecordType(RecordType *T) {
7643 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7644 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7645 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
7646 return VisitTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7647 Args.flat_size());
7648 }
7649
7650 return false;
7651}
7652
7653void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7654 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
7655 Marker.Visit(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
7656}
7657
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007658/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7659/// of the program being compiled.
7660///
7661/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007662/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007663/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7664/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7665/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7666/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007667/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007668/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007669///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007670/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7671/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7672/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7673/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007674bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007675 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7676 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7677 case Unevaluated:
7678 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7679 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007680
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007681 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7682 Diag(Loc, PD);
7683 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007684
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007685 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7686 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7687 break;
7688 }
7689
7690 return false;
7691}
7692
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007693bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7694 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7695 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7696 return false;
7697
7698 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7699 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7700 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7701 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007702
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007703 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007704 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007705 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7706 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007707 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007708 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7709 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7710 return true;
7711
7712 return false;
7713}
7714
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007715// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
7716// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
7717void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
7718 SourceLocation Loc;
7719
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007720 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
7721
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007722 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
7723 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
7724 if (Op->getOpcode() != BinaryOperator::Assign)
7725 return;
7726
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007727 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
7728 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
7729 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
7730 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
7731
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00007732 // self = [<foo> init...]
7733 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
7734 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
7735 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7736
7737 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
7738 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
7739 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
7740 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
7741 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00007742
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007743 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7744 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
7745 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
7746 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
7747 return;
7748
7749 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
7750 } else {
7751 // Not an assignment.
7752 return;
7753 }
7754
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007755 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00007756 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007757
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007758 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007759 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007760 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007761 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
7762 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
7763 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007764}
7765
7766bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
7767 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
7768
7769 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007770 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00007771
7772 QualType T = E->getType();
7773
7774 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7775 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
7776 return true;
7777 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
7778 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
7779 << T << E->getSourceRange();
7780 return true;
7781 }
7782 }
7783
7784 return false;
7785}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007786
7787Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
7788 ExprArg SubExpr) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00007789 Expr *Sub = SubExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
7790 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007791 return ExprError();
7792
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00007793 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc)) {
7794 Sub->Destroy(Context);
7795 return ExprError();
7796 }
7797
7798 return Owned(Sub);
7799}